blob: ac9fc01c20c70015ef1671c08ac468b6ca415f91 [file] [log] [blame]
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner081ce942007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman089efff2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
15// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
17// into:
18// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
19//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
22// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
23// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
25// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
27// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
29// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
32// ... etc.
33//
34//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
36#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
37#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
38#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
39#include "llvm/Pass.h"
40#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
41#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
42#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnera432bc72008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
47#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky0185bbf2008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
50#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
51#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
52#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
53#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
54#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
55#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
56#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
57#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
58#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
59#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
60#include <algorithm>
Edwin Töröka0e6fce2008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000062#include <sstream>
63using namespace llvm;
64using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
65
66STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
71
72namespace {
73 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
76 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnera06291a2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
79 TargetData *TD;
80 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
81 public:
82 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohman26f8c272008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000084
85 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman55d19662008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
109
110
111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
117 UI != UE; ++UI)
118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
119 }
120
121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
128 }
129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
148
149 public:
150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
153
154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
158 }
159
160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
168 //
169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner76972db2008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
200
201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
204 BinaryOperator &I);
205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerdf7e8402008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerdeef1a72008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner7c1626482008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
223 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000224 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
225 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
226 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
227 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
228 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
229 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
230 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
231 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
232 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
233 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
234 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
235 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
236 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmanda9ef702008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000237 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000238
239 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
240 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
241
242 private:
243 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
244 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000245 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000246 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
247 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3554f972008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000248 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000249
250 public:
251 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
252 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
253 //
254 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
255 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
256 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
257 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
258 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
259 AddToWorkList(New);
260 return New;
261 }
262
263 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
264 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
265 /// cast.
266 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
267 Instruction &Pos) {
268 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
269
270 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
271 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
272
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000273 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000274 AddToWorkList(C);
275 return C;
276 }
Chris Lattner13c2d6e2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000277
278 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
279 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
280 }
281
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000282
283 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
284 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
285 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
286 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
287 // modified.
288 //
289 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
290 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
291 if (&I != V) {
292 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
293 return &I;
294 } else {
295 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
296 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
297 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
298 return &I;
299 }
300 }
301
302 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
303 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
304 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
305 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
306 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
307 //
308 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
309 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
310 if (Old != New)
311 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
312 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
313 AddToWorkList(I);
314 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
315 AddToWorkList(I);
316 return true;
317 }
318
319 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
320 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
321 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
322 // this function.
323 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
324 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
325 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
326 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
327 I.eraseFromParent();
328 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
329 }
Chris Lattnera432bc72008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000330
331 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
332 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
333 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
334 }
335
336 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
337 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
338 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
339 }
340 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
341 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
342 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000343
344 private:
345 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
346 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
347 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
348 ///
349 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
350 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
351 Instruction *InsertBefore);
352
353 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
354 /// commutative operators.
355 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
356
357 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
358 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
359 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
360
361 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
362 /// on the demanded bits.
363 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
364 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
365 unsigned Depth = 0);
366
367 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
368 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
369
370 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
371 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
372 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
373 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
374
375 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
376 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
377 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
380
381
382 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
383 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
384
385 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
386 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
387 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
388 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
389 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
390 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
391 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner5af8a912008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000393 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000395
396 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000398 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
399 unsigned CastOpc,
400 int &NumCastsRemoved);
401 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
402 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmanda9ef702008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000403
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000404 };
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000405}
406
Dan Gohman089efff2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000407char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
408static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
409X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
410
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000411// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
412// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
413static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
414 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
415 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
416 return 3;
417 return 4;
418 }
419 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
420 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
421}
422
423// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
424// it.
425static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
426 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
427}
428
429// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
430// though a va_arg area...
431static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
432 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
433 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
434 return Type::Int32Ty;
435 }
436 return Ty;
437}
438
Matthijs Kooijman5e2a3182008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000439/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
440/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
441/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000442static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
443 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman5e2a3182008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000444 // BitCastInst?
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000445 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman5e2a3182008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000446 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
447 // GetElementPtrInst?
448 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
449 return GEP->getOperand(0);
450 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000451 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman5e2a3182008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000452 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000453 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman5e2a3182008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000454 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
455 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
456 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
457 I != E; ++I) {
458 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
459 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
460 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
461 return 0;
462 }
463 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
464 return CE->getOperand(0);
465 }
466 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000467 return 0;
468}
469
470/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
471/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
472static Instruction::CastOps
473isEliminableCastPair(
474 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
475 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
476 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
477 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
478) {
479
480 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
481 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
482
483 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
484 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
485 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
486
487 return Instruction::CastOps(
488 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
489 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
490}
491
492/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
493/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
494/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
495static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
496 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
497 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
498
499 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
500 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
501 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
502 return false;
503 return true;
504}
505
506/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
507/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
508/// casts that are known to not do anything...
509///
510Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
511 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
512 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
513 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
514 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
515 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
516
517 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
518}
519
520// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
521// operators:
522//
523// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
524// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
525// binary operators.
526//
527// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
528// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
529//
530bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
531 bool Changed = false;
532 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
533 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
534
535 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
536 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
537 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
538 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
539 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
540 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
541 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
542 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
543 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
544 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
545 return true;
546 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
547 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
548 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
549 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
550 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
551
552 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
553 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000554 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000555 Op1->getOperand(0),
556 Op1->getName(), &I);
557 AddToWorkList(New);
558 I.setOperand(0, New);
559 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
560 return true;
561 }
562 }
563 return Changed;
564}
565
566/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
567/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
568/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
569bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
570 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
571 return false;
572 I.swapOperands();
573 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
574 return true;
575}
576
577// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
578// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
579//
580static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
581 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
582 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
583
584 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
585 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
586 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky58867bc2008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000587
588 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
589 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
590 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
591
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000592 return 0;
593}
594
595static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
596 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
597 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
598
599 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
600 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
601 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
602 return 0;
603}
604
605// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
606// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
607// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
608// Otherwise, return null.
609//
610static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
611 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
612 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
613 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
614 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
615 return I->getOperand(0);
616 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
617 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
618 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
619 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
620 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
621 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
622 return I->getOperand(0);
623 }
624 }
625 return 0;
626}
627
628/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
629/// expression, return it.
630static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
631 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
632 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
633 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
634 return cast<User>(V);
635 return false;
636}
637
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000638/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
639/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohman8c397862008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000640static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
641 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000642 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohman8c397862008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000643 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000644 return CE->getOpcode();
645 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
646 return Instruction::UserOp1;
647}
648
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000649/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
650static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
651 APInt Val(C->getValue());
652 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
653}
654/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
655static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
656 APInt Val(C->getValue());
657 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
658}
659/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
660static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
661 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
662}
663/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
664static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
665 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
666}
667/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
668static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
669 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
670}
671/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
672static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
673 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
674}
Nick Lewycky9d798f92008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000675/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
676/// this size.
677static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
678 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
679 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
680 if (sign) {
681 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
682 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
683 } else {
684 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
685 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
686 }
687
688 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
689
690 if (sign) {
691 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
692 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
693 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
694 } else
695 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
696}
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000697
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000698
699/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
700/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
701/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
702/// constant and return true.
703static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
704 APInt Demanded) {
705 assert(I && "No instruction?");
706 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
707
708 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
709 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
710 if (!OpC) return false;
711
712 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
713 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
714 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
715 return false;
716
717 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
718 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
719 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
720 return true;
721}
722
723// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
724// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
725// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
726// min/max.
727static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
728 const APInt& KnownZero,
729 const APInt& KnownOne,
730 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
731 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
732 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
733 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
734 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
735 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
736 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
737
738 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
739 // bit if it is unknown.
740 Min = KnownOne;
741 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
742
743 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
744 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
745 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
746 }
747}
748
749// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
750// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
751// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
752// min/max.
753static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerb933ea62007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000754 const APInt &KnownZero,
755 const APInt &KnownOne,
756 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
757 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000758 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
759 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
760 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
761 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
762 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
763
764 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
765 Min = KnownOne;
766 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
767 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
768}
769
770/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
771/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
772/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
773/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
774/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
775/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
776/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
777/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
778/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
779/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
780/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
781/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
782/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
783/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
784/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
785bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
786 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
787 unsigned Depth) {
788 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
789 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
790 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
791 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
792 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
793 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
794 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
795 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
796 must have same BitWidth");
797 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
798 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
799 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
800 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
801 return false;
802 }
803
804 KnownZero.clear();
805 KnownOne.clear();
806 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
807 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
808 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
810 return false;
811 }
812 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
813 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
814 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
815 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
816 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
817 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
818 return false;
819 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
820 return false;
821 }
822
823 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
824 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
825
826 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
827 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
828 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohmanbec16052008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000829 default:
830 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
831 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000832 case Instruction::And:
833 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
834 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
835 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
836 return true;
837 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
838 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
839
840 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
841 // LHS.
842 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
843 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
844 return true;
845 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
846 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
847
848 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
849 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
850 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
851 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
852 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
853 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
854 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
855 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
856
857 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
858 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
859 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
860
861 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
862 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
863 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
864
865 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
866 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
867 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
868 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
869 break;
870 case Instruction::Or:
871 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
872 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
873 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
874 return true;
875 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
876 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
877 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
878 // LHS.
879 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
880 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
881 return true;
882 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
883 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
884
885 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
886 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
887 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
888 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
889 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
890 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
891 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
892 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
893
894 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
895 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
896 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
897 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
898 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
899 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
900 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
901 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
902
903 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
904 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
905 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
906
907 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
908 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
909 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
910 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
911 break;
912 case Instruction::Xor: {
913 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
914 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
915 return true;
916 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
917 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
918 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
919 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
920 return true;
921 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
922 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
923
924 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
925 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
926 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
927 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
928 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
930
931 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
932 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
933 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
934 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
935 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
936 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
937
938 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
939 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
940 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
941 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
942 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000943 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000944 I->getName());
945 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
947 }
948
949 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
950 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
951 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
952 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
953 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
954 // all known
955 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
956 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
957 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000958 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +0000959 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
960 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
961 }
962 }
963
964 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
965 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
966 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
967 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
968
969 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
970 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
971 break;
972 }
973 case Instruction::Select:
974 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
975 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
976 return true;
977 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
978 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
979 return true;
980 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
981 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
982 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
983 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
984
985 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
986 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
987 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
988 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
989 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
990
991 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
992 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
993 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
994 break;
995 case Instruction::Trunc: {
996 uint32_t truncBf =
997 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
998 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
999 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1000 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1001 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1002 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1003 return true;
1004 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1005 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1007 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1008 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1009 break;
1010 }
1011 case Instruction::BitCast:
1012 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1013 return false;
1014
1015 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1016 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1017 return true;
1018 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1019 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1020 break;
1021 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1022 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1023 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1024 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
1025
1026 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1027 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1028 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1029 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1030 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1031 return true;
1032 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1033 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 // The top bits are known to be zero.
1038 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
1039 break;
1040 }
1041 case Instruction::SExt: {
1042 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1043 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1044 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
1045
1046 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
1047 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
1048
1049 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
1050 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1051 // bit is demanded.
1052 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
1053 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
1054
1055 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1056 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1057 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1058 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1059 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1060 return true;
1061 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1062 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1063 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1064 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1065 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1066
1067 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1068 // top bits of the result.
1069
1070 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1071 // convert this into a zero extension.
1072 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
1073 {
1074 // Convert to ZExt cast
1075 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1076 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
1077 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
1078 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
1079 }
1080 break;
1081 }
1082 case Instruction::Add: {
1083 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1084 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1085 // either.
1086 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1087
1088 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1089 // we can do.
1090 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1091 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1092 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1093 if (RHS->isZero())
1094 break;
1095
1096 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1097 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
1098 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
1099
1100 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1101 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1102 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1103 return true;
1104
1105 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1106 // the constant.
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Avoid excess work.
1111 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1112 break;
1113
1114 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1115 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1116 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001117 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001118 I->getName());
1119 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1120 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1121 }
1122
1123 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1124 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1125 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1126 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1127 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1128
1129 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1130 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1131 // this scan.
1132 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1133 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
1134
1135 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1136
1137 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1138 // other, and there is no input carry.
1139 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1140 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1141
1142 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1143 // is no input carry.
1144 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1145 } else {
1146 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1147 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
1148 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
1149 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1150 // significant bit and all those below it.
1151 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
1152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1156 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1157 return true;
1158 }
1159 }
1160 break;
1161 }
1162 case Instruction::Sub:
1163 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1164 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
1165 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
1166 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1167 // significant bit and all those below it.
1168 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1169 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
1170 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1171 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1172 return true;
1173 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1174 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1175 return true;
1176 }
Dan Gohmanbec16052008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001177 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1178 // the known zeros and ones.
1179 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001180 break;
1181 case Instruction::Shl:
1182 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1183 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
1184 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1185 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
1186 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1187 return true;
1188 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1189 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1190 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1191 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1192 // low bits known zero.
1193 if (ShiftAmt)
1194 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
1195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::LShr:
1198 // For a logical shift right
1199 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1200 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
1201
1202 // Unsigned shift right.
1203 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1204 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
1205 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1206 return true;
1207 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1208 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1209 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1210 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1211 if (ShiftAmt) {
1212 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
1213 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
1214 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1215 }
1216 }
1217 break;
1218 case Instruction::AShr:
1219 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1220 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1221 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1222 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1223 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1224 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001225 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001226 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1227 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1228 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1229 }
1230
1231 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1232 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1233 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1234 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1235
1236 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1237 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
1238
1239 // Signed shift right.
1240 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1241 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1242 // demanded.
1243 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1244 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
1245 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
1246 DemandedMaskIn,
1247 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1248 return true;
1249 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1250 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1251 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
1252 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
1253 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1254 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1255
1256 // Handle the sign bits.
1257 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1258 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1259 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1260
1261 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1262 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng533604e2008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001263 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001264 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1265 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001266 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001267 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1268 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1269 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1270 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1271 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1372c82008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001275 case Instruction::SRem:
1276 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckycfaaece2008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001277 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1278 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky245de422008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001279 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1280 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1281
Nick Lewyckycfaaece2008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001282 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1372c82008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001283 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1285 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
1288 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1289 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1372c82008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001290
1291 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1372c82008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001292
1293 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1294 }
1295 }
1296 break;
Dan Gohmanbec16052008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001297 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohmanbec16052008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001298 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1299 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohman23ea06d2008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1301 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303
Dan Gohmanbec16052008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001304 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohman23ea06d2008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001305 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohmanbec16052008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001306 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1307 return true;
1308
1309 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1310 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1311 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1372c82008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001312 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001313 }
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001314 case Instruction::Call:
1315 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1316 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1317 default: break;
1318 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1319 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1320 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1321 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1322 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1323
1324 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1325 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1326 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1327 NLZ &= ~7;
1328 NTZ &= ~7;
1329 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1330 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1331 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1332 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1333
1334 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1335 // the right place.
1336 Instruction *NewVal;
1337 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1338 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1339 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1340 else
1341 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1342 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1343 NewVal->takeName(I);
1344 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1345 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1346 }
1347
1348 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1349 break;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
Chris Lattner4946e222008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001353 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001354 break;
Dan Gohmanbec16052008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001355 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001356
1357 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1358 // constant.
1359 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1360 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1361 return false;
1362}
1363
1364
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001365/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001366/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1367/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1368/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1369///
1370/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1371/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1372/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1373Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1374 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1375 unsigned Depth) {
1376 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
1377 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1378 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001379 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001380
1381 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1382 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1383 UndefElts = EltMask;
1384 return 0;
1385 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1386 UndefElts = EltMask;
1387 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1388 }
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001389
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001390 UndefElts = 0;
1391 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1392 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
1393 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1394
1395 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1396 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1397 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1398 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1399 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1400 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1401 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1402 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1403 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1404 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1405 }
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001406
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001407 // If we changed the constant, return it.
1408 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
1409 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1410 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
1411 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
1412 // set to undef.
Mon P Wang927daf52008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001413
1414 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1415 // anything.
1416 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1417 return 0;
1418
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001419 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
1420 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1421 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1422 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1423 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1424 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1425 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
1426 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
1427 }
1428
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001429 // Limit search depth.
1430 if (Depth == 10)
1431 return false;
1432
1433 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1434 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1435 // are needed.
1436 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1437 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1438 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1439 // the main instcombine process.
1440 if (Depth != 0)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001441 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1442 return false;
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001443
1444 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1445 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001446 }
1447
1448 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1449 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1450
1451 bool MadeChange = false;
1452 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1453 Value *TmpV;
1454 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1455 default: break;
1456
1457 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1458 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1459 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
1460 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
1461 if (Idx == 0) {
1462 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1463 // which elt is getting updated.
1464 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1465 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1466 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1467 break;
1468 }
1469
1470 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1471 // insertelement.
1472 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
1473 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1474 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1475
1476 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1477 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1478 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1479 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1480 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1481 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1482
1483 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001484 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1485 break;
1486 }
1487 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1488 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001489 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1490 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001491 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1492 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1493 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1494 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1495 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001496 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001497 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001498 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001499 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1500 else
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001501 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001502 }
1503 }
1504 }
1505
1506 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1507 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1508 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1509
1510 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1511 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1512 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1513 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1514
1515 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1516 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1517 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohman24f6ee22008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001518 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001519 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1520 UndefElts |= NewBit;
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001521 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001522 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1523 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1524 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1525 } else {
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001526 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - LHSVWidth)) & 1) << i;
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001527 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1528 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1529 }
1530 }
1531
1532 if (NewUndefElts) {
1533 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1534 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1535 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1536 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1537 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1538 else
1539 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1540 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1541 }
1542 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1543 MadeChange = true;
1544 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001545 break;
1546 }
1547 case Instruction::BitCast: {
1548 // Vector->vector casts only.
1549 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1550 if (!VTy) break;
1551 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1552 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1553 unsigned Ratio;
1554
1555 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
1556 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
1557 // elements as are demanded of us.
1558 Ratio = 1;
1559 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1560 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1561 // Untested so far.
1562 break;
1563
1564 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1565 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1566 // elements are live.
1567 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1568 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1569 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1570 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1571 }
1572 } else {
1573 // Untested so far.
1574 break;
1575
1576 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1577 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1578 // live.
1579 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1580 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1581 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1582 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1583 }
1584
1585 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1586 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1587 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1588 if (TmpV) {
1589 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1590 MadeChange = true;
1591 }
1592
1593 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1594 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1595 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1596 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1597 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1598 // undef.
1599 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1600 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1601 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1602 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1603 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1604 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1605 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1606 // elements are undef.
1607 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1608 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1609 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1610 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1611 }
1612 break;
1613 }
1614 case Instruction::And:
1615 case Instruction::Or:
1616 case Instruction::Xor:
1617 case Instruction::Add:
1618 case Instruction::Sub:
1619 case Instruction::Mul:
1620 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1621 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1622 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1623 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1624 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1625 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1626 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1627
1628 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1629 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1630 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1631 break;
1632
1633 case Instruction::Call: {
1634 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1635 if (!II) break;
1636 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1637 default: break;
1638
1639 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1640 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1642 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1643 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1644 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1645 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1646 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1647 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1648 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1649 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1650 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1651 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1652 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1653 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1654 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1655
1656 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1657 // scalarize it now.
1658 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1659 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1660 default: break;
1661 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1662 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1663 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1664 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1665 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1666 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1667 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1668 // Extract the element as scalars.
1669 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1670 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1671
1672 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1673 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1674 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1675 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001676 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001677 II->getName()), *II);
1678 break;
1679 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1680 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001681 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001682 II->getName()), *II);
1683 break;
1684 }
1685
1686 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001687 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1688 II->getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001689 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1690 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1691 return New;
1692 }
1693 }
1694
1695 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1696 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1697 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1698 break;
1699 }
1700 break;
1701 }
1702 }
1703 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1704}
1705
Dan Gohman5d56fd42008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001706
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001707/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1708/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1709/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1710/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1711/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1712/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1713/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1714///
1715template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohmand8bcf5b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001716static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001717 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1718 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1719
1720 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1721 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1722 return F.apply(Root);
1723
1724 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1725 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
1726 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
1727 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1728 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1729
1730 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1731 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1732 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1733 ShouldApply = true;
1734 }
1735
1736 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1737 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1738 if (ShouldApply) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001739 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1740 // and perform the reassociation.
1741 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1742
1743 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1744 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1745
1746 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1747 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
1748 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
1749 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1750 return 0;
1751 }
1752 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
1753 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001754 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohman0bb9a3d2008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001755 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001756 ARI = Root;
1757
1758 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1759 // get to LHSI.
1760 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1761 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
1762 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1763 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohman0bb9a3d2008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001764 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001765 ARI = NextLHSI;
1766
1767 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1768 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1769 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1770 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1771 }
1772
1773 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1774 // the transformation...
1775 return F.apply(Root);
1776 }
1777
1778 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1779 }
1780 return 0;
1781}
1782
Dan Gohman089efff2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001783namespace {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001784
Nick Lewycky27f6c132008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001785// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001786struct AddRHS {
1787 Value *RHS;
1788 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1789 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1790 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky27f6c132008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001791 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1792 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001793 }
1794};
1795
1796// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1797// iff C1&C2 == 0
1798struct AddMaskingAnd {
1799 Constant *C2;
1800 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1801 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
1802 ConstantInt *C1;
1803 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
1804 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
1805 }
1806 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001807 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001808 }
1809};
1810
Dan Gohman089efff2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001811}
1812
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001813static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
1814 InstCombiner *IC) {
1815 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
1816 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
1817 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
1818
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001819 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001820 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
1821 }
1822
1823 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
1824 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1825 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
1826
1827 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1828 if (ConstIsRHS)
1829 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1830 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
1831 }
1832
1833 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1834 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1835 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1836 Instruction *New;
1837 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001838 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001839 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001840 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001841 SO->getName()+".cmp");
1842 else {
1843 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
1844 abort();
1845 }
1846 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1847}
1848
1849// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1850// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1851// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1852// not have a second operand.
1853static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1854 InstCombiner *IC) {
1855 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1856 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1857 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1858 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1859
1860 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
1861 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
1862 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
1863
1864 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1865 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1866
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001867 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1868 SelectFalseVal);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001869 }
1870 return 0;
1871}
1872
1873
1874/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1875/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1876/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1877Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1878 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
1879 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
1880 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
1881
1882 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1883 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
1884 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
1885 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1886 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1887 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1888 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
1889 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
1890 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1891
1892 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1893 // loop.
1894 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1895 return 0;
1896 }
1897
1898 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1899 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1900 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1901 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1902 if (NonConstBB) {
1903 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1904 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1905 }
1906
1907 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001908 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001909 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
1910 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
1911 NewPN->takeName(PN);
1912
1913 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1914 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1915 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1916 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnerb933ea62007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001917 Value *InV = 0;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001918 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1919 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1920 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1921 else
1922 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
1923 } else {
1924 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1925 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001926 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001927 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1928 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1929 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001930 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001931 CI->getPredicate(),
1932 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1933 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1934 else
1935 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1936
1937 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
1938 }
1939 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
1940 }
1941 } else {
1942 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1943 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
1944 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
1945 Value *InV;
1946 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1947 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
1948 } else {
1949 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001950 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001951 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1952 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1953 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
1954 }
1955 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
1956 }
1957 }
1958 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1959}
1960
Chris Lattner55476162008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001961
Chris Lattner3554f972008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001962/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1963/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1964/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1965/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1966bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1967 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1968 // ones.
1969
1970 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1971 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1972 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1973 // sign extend fine.
1974 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1975 return true;
1976
1977
1978 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1979 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1980 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1981 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1982
1983 // TODO: Implement.
1984
1985 return false;
1986}
1987
Chris Lattner55476162008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001988
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00001989Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
1990 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
1991 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
1992
1993 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
1994 // X + undef -> undef
1995 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1997
1998 // X + 0 --> X
1999 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
2000 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2001 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2002 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen2fc20782007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002003 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
2004 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2006 }
2007
2008 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
2009 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
2010 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
2011 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
2012 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002013 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002014
2015 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2016 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
2017 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2018 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2019 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2020 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2021 return &I;
2022 }
Dan Gohman35b76162008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002023
2024 // zext(i1) - 1 -> select i1, 0, -1
2025 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
2026 if (CI->isAllOnesValue() &&
2027 ZI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2028 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0),
2029 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2030 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002031 }
2032
2033 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2034 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2035 return NV;
2036
2037 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2038 Value *XorLHS = 0;
2039 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2040 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
2041 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2042 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
2043
2044 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
2045 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2046 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
2047 do {
2048 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
2049 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2050 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
2051 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2052 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
2053 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
2054 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2055 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
2056 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
2057 break;
2058 }
2059 }
2060 Size >>= 1;
2061 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2062 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2063 } while (Size >= 1);
2064
2065 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattnerdeef1a72008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002066 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2067 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2068 // that the back ends can handle.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002069 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2070 switch (Size) {
2071 default: break;
2072 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2073 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2074 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2075 }
2076 if (MiddleType) {
2077 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
2078 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
2079 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
2080 }
2081 }
2082 }
2083
Nick Lewyckyd4b63672008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002084 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2085 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2086
Nick Lewycky4d474cd2008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002087 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewyckyd4b63672008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002088 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002089 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
2090
2091 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2092 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2093 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2094 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2095 }
2096 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2097 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2098 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2099 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2100 }
2101 }
2102
2103 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattner53c9fbf2008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002104 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2105 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattner322a9192008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002106 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2107 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002108 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattner322a9192008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002109 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002110 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattner322a9192008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002111 }
Chris Lattner53c9fbf2008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002112 }
2113
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002114 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattner53c9fbf2008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002115 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002116
2117 // A + -B --> A - B
2118 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2119 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002120 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002121
2122
2123 ConstantInt *C2;
2124 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2125 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002126 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002127
2128 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2129 ConstantInt *C1;
2130 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002131 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002132 }
2133
2134 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
2135 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002136 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002137
2138 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
2139 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2140 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
2141
2142
2143 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
2144 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
2145 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2146 return R;
Chris Lattnerc1575ce2008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002147
2148 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2149 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2150 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2151 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2152 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2153 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2154 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2155 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2156 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2157 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2158
2159 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner130443c2008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002160 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerc1575ce2008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002161 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerc1575ce2008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002162 }
2163 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002164
Nick Lewycky83598a72008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002165 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky5d03b512008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002166 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewycky83598a72008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002167 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2168 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2169 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2170 if (W != Y) {
2171 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling44a36ea2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002172 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewycky83598a72008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002173 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling44a36ea2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002174 std::swap(W, X);
2175 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewycky83598a72008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002176 std::swap(Y, Z);
2177 std::swap(W, X);
2178 }
2179 }
2180
2181 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002182 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewycky83598a72008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002183 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002184 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewycky83598a72008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002185 }
2186 }
2187 }
2188
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002189 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2190 Value *X = 0;
2191 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002192 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002193
2194 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2195 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
2196 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
2197 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2198 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2199 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
2200 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
2201
2202 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
2203 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
2204
2205 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
2206 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
2207
2208 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2209 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002210 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002211 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002212 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002213 }
2214 }
2215 }
2216
2217 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2218 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
2219 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2220 return R;
2221 }
2222
2223 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattnerbf0c5f32007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002224 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002225 {
2226 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2227 Value *Other = RHS;
2228 if (!CI) {
2229 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2230 Other = LHS;
2231 }
2232 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
2233 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2234 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2235 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lambbb2f2222007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002236 unsigned AS =
2237 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner13c2d6e2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002238 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2239 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002240 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002241 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
2242 }
2243 }
Christopher Lamb244ec282007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002244
Chris Lattnerbf0c5f32007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002245 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb244ec282007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002246 {
2247 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2248 Value *Other = RHS;
2249 if (!SI) {
2250 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2251 Other = LHS;
2252 }
Chris Lattnerbf0c5f32007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002253 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb244ec282007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002254 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2255 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattnerbf0c5f32007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002256 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb244ec282007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002257
2258 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2259 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattnerbf0c5f32007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002260 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2261 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002262 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattnerbf0c5f32007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002263 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2264 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002265 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb244ec282007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002266 }
2267 }
Chris Lattner55476162008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002268
2269 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2270 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2271 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2272 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002273
Chris Lattner3554f972008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002274 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2275 // integer add followed by a sext.
2276 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2277 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2278 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2279 Constant *CI =
2280 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2281 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2282 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2283 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2284 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2285 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2286 CI, "addconv");
2287 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2288 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2289 }
2290 }
2291
2292 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2293 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2294 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2295 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2296 // integer add will not overflow.
2297 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2298 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2299 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2300 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2301 // Insert the new integer add.
2302 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2303 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2304 "addconv");
2305 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2306 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2307 }
2308 }
2309 }
2310
2311 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2312 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2313 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2314 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2315 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2316 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2317 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2318 // instcombined.
2319 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2320 Constant *CI =
2321 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2322 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2323 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2324 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2325 // Insert the new integer add.
2326 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2327 CI, "addconv");
2328 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2329 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2330 }
2331 }
2332
2333 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2334 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2335 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2336 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2337 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2338 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2339 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2340 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2341 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2342 // Insert the new integer add.
2343 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2344 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2345 "addconv");
2346 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2347 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2348 }
2349 }
2350 }
2351
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002352 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2353}
2354
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002355Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
2356 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2357
Chris Lattner27fbef42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002358 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2359 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2361
2362 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
2363 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002364 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002365
2366 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2368 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2369 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2370
2371 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2372 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
2373 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002374 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002375
2376 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
2377 Value *X = 0;
2378 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002379 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002380
2381 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2382 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
2383 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002384 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002385 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
2386 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2387 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
2388 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
2389 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
2390 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002391 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002392 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
2393 }
2394 }
2395 }
2396 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2397 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2398 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
2399 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
2400 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
2401 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002402 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002403 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
2404 }
2405 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002406 }
2407 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002408 }
2409
2410 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2411 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
2412 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2413 return R;
2414
2415 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2416 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2417 return NV;
2418 }
2419
Nick Lewyckyd4b63672008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002420 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2421 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2422
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002423 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2424 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
2425 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
2426 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002427 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002428 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002429 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002430 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2431 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2432 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002433 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002434 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2435 }
2436 }
2437
2438 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
2439 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2440 // is not used by anyone else...
2441 //
2442 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
2443 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
2444 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2445 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2446 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2447 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
2448
2449 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002450 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002451 }
2452
2453 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2454 //
2455 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2456 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2457 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2458
2459 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002460 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2461 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002462 }
2463
2464 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
2465 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
2466 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
2467 if (CSI->isZero())
2468 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002469 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002470 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2471
2472 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
2473 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
2474 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
2475 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002476 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002477 }
Dan Gohmanda338742007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002478
2479 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2480 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2481 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2482 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2483 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2484 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002485 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanda338742007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002486 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002487 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanda338742007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002488 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002489 }
2490 }
2491
2492 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002493 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002494 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
2495 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2496 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2497 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2498 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
2499 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2500 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002501 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002502 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002503 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002504
2505 ConstantInt *C1;
2506 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
2507 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002508 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002509
2510 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2511 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002512 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002513 }
2514 return 0;
2515}
2516
2517/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2518/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2519/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2520/// signed.
2521static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2522 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
2523 switch (pred) {
2524 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2525 TrueIfSigned = true;
2526 return RHS->isZero();
2527 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2528 TrueIfSigned = true;
2529 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
2530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2531 TrueIfSigned = false;
2532 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
2533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2534 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2535 TrueIfSigned = true;
2536 return RHS->getValue() ==
2537 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2538 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2539 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2540 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner60813c22008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002541 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002542 default:
2543 return false;
2544 }
2545}
2546
2547Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
2548 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2549 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
2550
2551 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2553
2554 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
2555 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2556 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2557
2558 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
2559 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2560 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2561 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002562 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002563 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
2564
2565 if (CI->isZero())
2566 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2567 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2569 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002570 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002571
2572 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
2573 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002574 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002575 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
2576 }
2577 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
2578 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2580
2581 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2582 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattner6297fc72008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002583 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2584 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2585 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2586 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2587 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2588
2589 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2590 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2591 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2592 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002594 }
2595
2596 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2597 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner58194082008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002598 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002599 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002600 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002601 Op1, "tmp");
2602 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2603 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2604 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002605 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002606
2607 }
2608
2609 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2610 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2611 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2612 return R;
2613
2614 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2615 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2616 return NV;
2617 }
2618
2619 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2620 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002621 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002622
Nick Lewyckyd4b63672008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002623 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2624 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2625
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002626 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2627 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2628 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2629 // formed.
2630 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewyckyd4b63672008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002631 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002632 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2633 BoolCast = CI;
2634 if (!BoolCast)
2635 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
2636 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2637 BoolCast = CI;
2638 if (BoolCast) {
2639 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
2640 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2641 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
2642 bool TIS = false;
2643
2644 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
2645 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2646 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
2647 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2648 TIS) {
2649 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
2650 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
2651 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
2652 Value *V =
2653 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002654 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002655 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2656 ".mask"), I);
2657
2658 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2659 // or truncate to the multiply type.
2660 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
2661 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2662 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2663 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2664 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2665 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2666 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2667 }
2668
2669 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002670 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002671 }
2672 }
2673 }
2674
2675 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2676}
2677
Chris Lattner76972db2008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002678/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2679/// instruction.
2680bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2681 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2682
2683 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2684 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2685 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2686 if (ST->isNullValue())
2687 NonNullOperand = 2;
2688 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2689 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2690 if (ST->isNullValue())
2691 NonNullOperand = 1;
2692
2693 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2694 return false;
2695
2696 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2697
2698 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2699 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2700
2701 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2702 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2703 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2704 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2705 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2706
2707 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2708 // early exit.
2709 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2710 return true;
2711
2712 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2713 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2714
2715 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2716 --BBI;
2717 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2718 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2719 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2720 break;
2721
2722 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2723 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2724 I != E; ++I) {
2725 if (*I == SI) {
2726 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2727 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2728 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2729 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2730 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2731 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2732 }
2733 }
2734
2735 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2736 if (&*BBI == SI)
2737 SI = 0;
2738 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2739 SelectCond = 0;
2740
2741 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2742 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2743 break;
2744
2745 }
2746 return true;
2747}
2748
2749
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002750/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2751/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2752/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2753/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
2754Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2755 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2756
Chris Lattner653ef3c2008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002757 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2758 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2759 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2760 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2761 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002762 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner653ef3c2008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002763 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002764
2765 // X / undef -> undef
2766 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2767 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2768
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002769 return 0;
2770}
2771
2772/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2773/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2774/// division instructions.
2775/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
2776Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2777 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2778
Chris Lattnercefb36c2008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002779 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky386c0132008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002780 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2781 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2782 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2783 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2784 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2785 }
2786
2787 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2789 }
Chris Lattnercefb36c2008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002790
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002791 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2792 return Common;
Chris Lattner76972db2008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002793
2794 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2795 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2796 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2797 return &I;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002798
2799 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2800 // div X, 1 == X
2801 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2803
2804 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2805 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2806 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2807 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky9d798f92008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002808 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2809 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2810 else
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002811 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewycky9d798f92008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002812 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002813 }
2814
2815 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
2816 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2817 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2818 return R;
2819 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2820 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2821 return NV;
2822 }
2823 }
2824
2825 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2826 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
2827 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2828 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2829
Nick Lewyckyd4b63672008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002830 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2831 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2833
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002834 return 0;
2835}
2836
2837Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2838 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2839
2840 // Handle the integer div common cases
2841 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2842 return Common;
2843
2844 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2845 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2846 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2847 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2848 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002849 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002850 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
2851 }
2852
2853 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
2854 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2855 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2856 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
2857 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
2858 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
2859 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
2860 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
2861 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
2862 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002863 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002864 }
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002865 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002866 }
2867 }
2868 }
2869
2870 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2871 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2872 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
2873 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2874 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2875 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
2876 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
2877 // Compute the shift amounts
2878 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
2879 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2880 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002881 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002882 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2883 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2884
2885 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2886 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002887 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002888 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2889 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
2890
2891 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002892 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002893 }
2894 }
2895 return 0;
2896}
2897
2898Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2899 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2900
2901 // Handle the integer div common cases
2902 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2903 return Common;
2904
2905 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2906 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2907 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002908 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002909
2910 // -X/C -> X/-C
2911 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002912 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002913 }
2914
2915 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2916 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
2917 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
2918 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
2919 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmandb3dd962007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002920 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002921 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002922 }
2923 }
2924
2925 return 0;
2926}
2927
2928Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2929 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2930}
2931
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002932/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2933/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2934/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2935/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2936Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2937 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2938
Chris Lattner653ef3c2008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002939 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002940 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2941 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2943
Chris Lattner653ef3c2008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002944 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2945 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner653ef3c2008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002948 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002949 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
2951
2952 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattner76972db2008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002953 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2954 return &I;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002955
2956 return 0;
2957}
2958
2959/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2960/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2961/// remainder instructions.
2962/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2963Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2964 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2965
2966 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2967 return common;
2968
2969 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2970 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2971 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2972 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2973
2974 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2976
2977 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2978 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2979 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2980 return R;
2981 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2982 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2983 return NV;
2984 }
Nick Lewyckyc1372c82008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002985
2986 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2987 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2988 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2989 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2990 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2991 return &I;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00002992 }
2993 }
2994
2995 return 0;
2996}
2997
2998Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2999 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3000
3001 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3002 return common;
3003
3004 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3005 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3006 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3007 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3008 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
3009 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003010 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003011 }
3012
3013 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3014 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3015 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3016 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
3017 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3018 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003019 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003020 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003021 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003022 }
3023 }
3024 }
3025
3026 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3027 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3028 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3029 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3030 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3031 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
3032 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3033 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
3034 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003035 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003036 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003037 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003038 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003039 }
3040 }
3041 }
3042
3043 return 0;
3044}
3045
3046Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3047 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3048
Dan Gohmandb3dd962007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003049 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003050 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3051 return common;
3052
3053 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewyckycfadfbd2008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003054 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3055 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3056 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003057 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3058 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3059 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3060 return &I;
3061 }
Nick Lewycky5515c7a2008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003062
Dan Gohmandb3dd962007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003063 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003064 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmandb3dd962007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003065 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3066 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3067 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3068 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003069 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmandb3dd962007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003070 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003071 }
3072
3073 return 0;
3074}
3075
3076Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3077 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3078}
3079
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003080// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3081// constant.
3082static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
3083 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
3084}
3085
3086// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3087// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3088static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
3089 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
3090}
3091
3092/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
3093/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3094///
3095/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3096///
3097/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3098/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
3099///
3100/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3101/// 0 A > B
3102/// 1 A == B
3103/// 2 A < B
3104///
3105/// <=> Value Definition
3106/// 000 0 Always false
3107/// 001 1 A > B
3108/// 010 2 A == B
3109/// 011 3 A >= B
3110/// 100 4 A < B
3111/// 101 5 A != B
3112/// 110 6 A <= B
3113/// 111 7 Always true
3114///
3115static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3116 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
3117 // False -> 0
3118 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3119 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3120 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3121 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3122 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3123 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3124 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3125 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3126 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3127 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
3128 // True -> 7
3129 default:
3130 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
3131 return 0;
3132 }
3133}
3134
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003135/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3136/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3137/// predicate by reference.
3138static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3139 isOrdered = false;
3140 switch (CC) {
3141 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3142 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Chengf1f2cea2008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003143 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3144 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3145 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3146 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003147 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3148 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3149 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3150 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Chengf1f2cea2008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003151 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3152 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003153 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3154 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng72988052008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003155 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003156 default:
3157 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
3158 assert(0 && "Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
3159 return 0;
3160 }
3161}
3162
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003163/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3164/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohmanda338742007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003165/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003166/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003167static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3168 switch (code) {
3169 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
3170 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
3171 case 1:
3172 if (sign)
3173 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3174 else
3175 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3176 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3177 case 3:
3178 if (sign)
3179 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3180 else
3181 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3182 case 4:
3183 if (sign)
3184 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3185 else
3186 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3187 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3188 case 6:
3189 if (sign)
3190 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3191 else
3192 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
3193 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
3194 }
3195}
3196
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003197/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3198/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3199/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3200static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
3201 Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3202 switch (code) {
Evan Chengf1f2cea2008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003203 default: assert(0 && "Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003204 case 0:
3205 if (isordered)
3206 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
3207 else
3208 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
3209 case 1:
3210 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003211 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
3212 else
3213 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Chengf1f2cea2008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003214 case 2:
3215 if (isordered)
3216 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
3217 else
3218 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003219 case 3:
3220 if (isordered)
3221 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
3222 else
3223 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3224 case 4:
3225 if (isordered)
3226 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
3227 else
3228 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3229 case 5:
3230 if (isordered)
Evan Chengf1f2cea2008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003231 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
3232 else
3233 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
3234 case 6:
3235 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003236 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
3237 else
3238 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng72988052008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003239 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003240 }
3241}
3242
3243
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003244static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3245 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3246 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3247 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3248 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3249 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3250}
3251
3252namespace {
3253// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3254struct FoldICmpLogical {
3255 InstCombiner &IC;
3256 Value *LHS, *RHS;
3257 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3258 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3259 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3260 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
3261 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
3262 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3263 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003264 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3265 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003266 return false;
3267 }
3268 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3269 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3270 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3271 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3272 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
3273 }
3274
3275 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
3276 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
3277 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
3278 unsigned Code;
3279 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3280 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3281 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3282 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
3283 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
3284 }
3285
3286 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3287 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3288
3289 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
3290 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3291 return I;
3292 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3293 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3294 }
3295};
3296} // end anonymous namespace
3297
3298// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3299// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
3300// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
3301Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
3302 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3303 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
3304 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3305 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
3306 Constant *Together = 0;
3307 if (!Op->isShift())
3308 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
3309
3310 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3311 case Instruction::Xor:
3312 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
3313 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003314 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003315 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
3316 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003317 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003318 }
3319 break;
3320 case Instruction::Or:
3321 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3322 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
3323
3324 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3325 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003326 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003327 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
3328 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003329 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003330 }
3331 break;
3332 case Instruction::Add:
3333 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
3334 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3335 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3336 // single bit constant.
3337 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
3338
3339 // If there is only one bit set...
3340 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
3341 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3342 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3343 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
3344 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
3345
3346 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3347 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3348 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3349 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3350 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3351 // no effect.
3352 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3353 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3354 return &TheAnd;
3355 } else {
3356 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003357 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003358 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
3359 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003360 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003361 }
3362 }
3363 }
3364 }
3365 break;
3366
3367 case Instruction::Shl: {
3368 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3369 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3370 //
3371 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
3372 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
3373 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3374 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
3375
3376 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3377 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
3378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3379 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
3380 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3381 return &TheAnd;
3382 }
3383 break;
3384 }
3385 case Instruction::LShr:
3386 {
3387 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3388 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3389 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3390 //
3391 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
3392 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
3393 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3394 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
3395
3396 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3397 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
3398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3399 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3400 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3401 return &TheAnd;
3402 }
3403 break;
3404 }
3405 case Instruction::AShr:
3406 // Signed shr.
3407 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3408 // with an and.
3409 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
3410 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
3411 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
3412 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3413 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
3414 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
3415 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
3416 // Make the argument unsigned.
3417 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
3418 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003419 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003420 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003421 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003422 }
3423 }
3424 break;
3425 }
3426 return 0;
3427}
3428
3429
3430/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3431/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
3432/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3433/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
3434/// insert new instructions.
3435Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
3436 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3437 Instruction &IB) {
3438 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
3439 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
3440 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
3441
3442 if (Inside) {
3443 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
3444 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
3445
3446 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
3447 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
3448 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3449 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3450 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3451 }
3452
3453 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3454 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003455 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003456 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
3457 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3458 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
3459 }
3460
3461 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
3462 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
3463
3464 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
3465 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
3466 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
3467 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3468 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3469 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3470 }
3471
3472 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3473 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3474 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003475 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003476 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
3477 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3478 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
3479}
3480
3481// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3482// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3483// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3484// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
3485static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
3486 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
3487 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3488 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
3489
3490 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
3491 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
3492 // look for the first non-zero bit
3493 ME = V.getActiveBits();
3494 return true;
3495}
3496
3497/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3498/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3499/// the following xforms:
3500///
3501/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3502/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3503/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3504///
3505/// return (A +/- B).
3506///
3507Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
3508 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
3509 Instruction &I) {
3510 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3511 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3512 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3513
3514 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3515
3516 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3517 default: return 0;
3518 case Instruction::And:
3519 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
3520 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
3521 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3522 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3523 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
3524 break;
3525
3526 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3527 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3528 // is all N is, ignore it.
3529 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
3530 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
3531 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
3532 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
3533 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
3534 break;
3535 }
3536 }
3537 return 0;
3538 case Instruction::Or:
3539 case Instruction::Xor:
3540 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
3541 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3542 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
3543 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
3544 break;
3545 return 0;
3546 }
3547
3548 Instruction *New;
3549 if (isSub)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003550 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003551 else
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003552 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003553 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3554}
3555
3556Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
3557 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
3558 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3559
3560 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3561 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3562
3563 // and X, X = X
3564 if (Op0 == Op1)
3565 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3566
3567 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3568 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
3569 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3570 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3571 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3572 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3573 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3574 return &I;
3575 } else {
3576 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3577 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
3578 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
3579 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3580 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
3581 }
3582 }
3583
3584 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3585 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3586 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
3587
3588 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
3589 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
3590 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
3591 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3592 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3593 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3594 case Instruction::Xor:
3595 case Instruction::Or:
3596 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3597 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3598 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3599 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003600 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003601 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3602 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003603 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003604 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
3605 }
3606 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
3607 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3608 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003609 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003610 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3611 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003612 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003613 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3614 }
3615 }
3616
3617 break;
3618 case Instruction::Add:
3619 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3620 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3621 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3622 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003623 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003624 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003625 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003626 break;
3627
3628 case Instruction::Sub:
3629 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3630 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3631 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3632 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003633 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyffed71b2008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003634
Nick Lewyckya349ba42008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003635 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3636 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3637 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3638 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3639 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3640 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3641
Nick Lewyckyffed71b2008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003642 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewyckya349ba42008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003643 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3644 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyffed71b2008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003645 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3646 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3647 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3648 }
3649 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003650 break;
Nick Lewycky659ed4d2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003651
3652 case Instruction::Shl:
3653 case Instruction::LShr:
3654 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3655 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyf1b12222008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003656 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewycky659ed4d2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003657 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3658 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3659 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3660 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3661 }
3662 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003663 }
3664
3665 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
3666 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
3667 return Res;
3668 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
3669 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3670 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3671 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3672 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
3673 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
3674 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003675 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003676 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3677 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
3678 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3679 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3680 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003681 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003682 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3683 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
3684 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
3685 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3686 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
3687 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003688 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003689 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3690 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3691 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
3692 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
3693 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3694 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3695 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003696 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003697 }
3698 }
3699
3700 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3701 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
3702 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3703 return R;
3704 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3705 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3706 return NV;
3707 }
3708
3709 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3710 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
3711
3712 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3713 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3714
3715 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
3716 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003717 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003718 I.getName()+".demorgan");
3719 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003720 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003721 }
3722
3723 {
3724 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3725 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3726 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3727 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3728
3729 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3730 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3731 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003732 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003733 }
3734 }
3735
3736 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3737 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3738 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3739
3740 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3741 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3742 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003743 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003744 }
3745 }
3746
3747 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3748 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3749 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3750 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3751 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3752 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3753 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3754 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3755 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3756 }
3757 }
3758 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3759 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3760 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3761 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3762 std::swap(A, B);
3763 }
3764 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003765 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003766 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003767 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003768 }
3769 }
3770 }
3771
Nick Lewycky771d6052008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003772 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3773 // where C is a power of 2
3774 Value *A, *B;
3775 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Cheng94fd9742008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003776 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3777 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewycky771d6052008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003778 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3779 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3780 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3781 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3782 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3783 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3784 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3785 }
3786 }
3787
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003788 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3789 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3790 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
3791 return R;
3792
3793 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3794 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3795 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3796 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3797 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3798 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3799 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3800 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3801 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3802 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner205ad1d2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003803 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3804
3805 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3806 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3807 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3808 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003809 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattnerda628ca2008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003810 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3811 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3812 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3813 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3814 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3815 else
3816 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3817
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003818 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3819 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
3820 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
3821 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3822 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3823 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3824 }
3825
3826 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3827 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3828 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3829 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3830 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3831 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3832 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3833
3834 switch (LHSCC) {
3835 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3836 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3837 switch (RHSCC) {
3838 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3839 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3840 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3841 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3842 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3843 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3844 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3845 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3847 }
3848 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3849 switch (RHSCC) {
3850 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3851 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3852 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3853 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3854 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3855 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3856 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3857 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3858 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3859 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3860 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3861 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3863 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3864 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
3865 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003866 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003867 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3868 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
3869 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3870 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
3871 }
3872 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3873 }
3874 break;
3875 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3876 switch (RHSCC) {
3877 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
3880 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3882 break;
3883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3884 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3885 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3886 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3887 break;
3888 }
3889 break;
3890 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3891 switch (RHSCC) {
3892 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3893 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
3895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3896 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3897 break;
3898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3899 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3901 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3902 break;
3903 }
3904 break;
3905 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3906 switch (RHSCC) {
3907 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman22b85622008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003909 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3912 break;
3913 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3914 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3915 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3916 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3917 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3918 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3919 true, I);
3920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3921 break;
3922 }
3923 break;
3924 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3925 switch (RHSCC) {
3926 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnerab0fc252007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003927 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003928 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3929 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3930 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3931 break;
3932 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3933 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3934 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3935 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3936 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3937 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3938 true, I);
3939 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3940 break;
3941 }
3942 break;
3943 }
3944 }
3945 }
3946
3947 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
3948 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3949 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3950 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3951 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
3952 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
3953 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
3954 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3955 I.getType(), TD) &&
3956 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3957 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003958 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003959 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3960 I.getName());
3961 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003962 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003963 }
3964 }
3965
3966 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
3967 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3968 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3969 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
3970 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3971 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3972 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003973 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003974 SI1->getOperand(0),
3975 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003976 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00003977 SI1->getOperand(1));
3978 }
3979 }
3980
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003981 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003982 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3983 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3984 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003985 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3986 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003987 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3988 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3989 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3990 // false.
Chris Lattnera6c7dce2007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003991 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3993 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3994 RHS->getOperand(0));
3995 }
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003996 } else {
3997 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
3998 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
3999 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4000 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
Evan Chengf1f2cea2008-10-14 18:13:38 +00004001 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4002 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4003 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4004 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4005 }
Evan Cheng0ac3a4d2008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004006 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4007 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4008 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4009 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4010 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
4011 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4013 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4015 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4016 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4017 bool Op0Ordered;
4018 bool Op1Ordered;
4019 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4020 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4021 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4022 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4023 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4024 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4025 }
4026 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4027 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4028 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4029 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4031 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4032 // uno && ord -> false
4033 if (!Op0Ordered)
4034 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4035 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4036 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4037 Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
4038 }
4039 }
4040 }
4041 }
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004042 }
4043 }
Nick Lewyckyffed71b2008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004044
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004045 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4046}
4047
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004048/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4049/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4050/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4051/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4052/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4053/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4054/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4055/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4056/// match.
4057///
4058/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4059/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4060/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4061/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4062/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4063/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4064///
4065/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4066/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4067/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4068/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4069/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4070///
4071static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4072 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4073 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4074 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4075 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4076 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4077 ByteValues) ||
4078 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4079 ByteValues);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004080 }
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004081
4082 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4083 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4084 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4085 unsigned ShAmt =
4086 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4087 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4088 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4089 return true;
4090
4091 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4092 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4093 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4094 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4095 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4096 } else {
4097 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4098 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4099 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattner44448592008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004100 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004101 }
4102
4103 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4104 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4105
4106 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4107 ByteValues);
4108 }
4109
4110 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4111 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4112 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4113 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4114 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4115 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4116 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4117 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4118
4119 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4120 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4121 // the and mask is.
4122 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4123 continue;
4124
4125 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4126 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4127 if (MaskB == 0) {
4128 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4129 continue;
4130 }
4131
4132 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4133 if (MaskB != Byte)
4134 return true;
4135
4136 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4137 }
4138
4139 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4140 ByteValues);
4141 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004142 }
4143
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004144 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4145 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4146 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4147 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4148 // their ultimate destination.
4149 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4150 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004151
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004152 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4153 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4154 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4155 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4156 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4157 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4158 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4159 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4160 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4161 return true;
4162 } else {
4163 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4164 return true;
4165 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004166
4167 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4168 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004169 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004170 return true;
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004171 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004172 return false;
4173}
4174
4175/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4176/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4177Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
4178 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004179 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4180 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4181 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004182 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
4183
4184 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4185 /// defines each byte.
4186 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
4187 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
4188
4189 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner567f5112008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004190 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4191 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004192 return 0;
4193
4194 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4195 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4196 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4197
4198 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4199 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4200 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4201 return 0;
Chandler Carrutha228e392007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004202 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004203 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carrutha228e392007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004204 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004205 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004206}
4207
Chris Lattnerdd7772b2008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004208/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4209/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4210/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4211static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
4212 Value *C, Value *D) {
4213 // If A is not a select of constants, this can't match.
4214 Value *Cond = 0, *Cond2 = 0;
4215 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
4216 if (!match(A, m_Select(m_Value(Cond), m_ConstantInt(C1), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
4217 return 0;
4218
4219#define SELECT_MATCH(Val, I1, I2) \
4220 m_Select(m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(I1), m_ConstantInt(I2))
4221
4222 // Handle "cond ? -1 : 0".
4223 if (C1->isAllOnesValue() && C2->isZero()) {
4224 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
4225 if (match(D, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(Cond2, -1, 0))) && Cond2 == Cond)
4226 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4227 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
4228 if (match(B, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(Cond2, -1, 0))) && Cond2 == Cond)
4229 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
4230 }
4231#undef SELECT_MATCH
4232
4233 return 0;
4234}
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004235
4236Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
4237 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
4238 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4239
4240 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
4241 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
4242
4243 // or X, X = X
4244 if (Op0 == Op1)
4245 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4246
4247 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4248 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
4249 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4250 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4251 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4252 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4253 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4254 return &I;
4255 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4257 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4258 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
4260 }
4261
4262
4263
4264 // or X, -1 == -1
4265 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
4266 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
4267 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4268 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004269 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004270 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
4271 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004272 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004273 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
4274 }
4275
4276 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4277 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004278 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004279 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
4280 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004281 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004282 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
4283 }
4284
4285 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4286 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
4287 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
4288 return R;
4289 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4290 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4291 return NV;
4292 }
4293
4294 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4295 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
4296
4297 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4298 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4299 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4300 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4301 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4302 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4303
4304 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4305 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
4306 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4307 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4308 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4309 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
4310 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4311 return BSwap;
4312 }
4313
4314 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4315 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
4316 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004317 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004318 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4319 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004320 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004321 }
4322
4323 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4324 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
4325 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004326 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004327 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4328 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004329 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004330 }
4331
4332 // (A & C)|(B & D)
4333 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
4334 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4335 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
4336 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4337 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4338 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4339 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4340 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4341 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4342 // replace with V+N.
4343 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4344 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4345 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4346 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4347 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4349 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4351 }
4352 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4353 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4354 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4355 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4356 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4358 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4360 }
4361 }
4362 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
4363 }
4364
4365 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4366 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
4367 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4368 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4369 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4370 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4371 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4372 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4373 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4374 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4375 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4376
4377 if (V1) {
4378 Value *Or =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004379 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4380 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004381 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004382 }
Dan Gohman279952c2008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004383
Dan Gohman35b76162008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004384 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Chris Lattnerdd7772b2008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004385 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D))
4386 return Match;
4387 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C))
4388 return Match;
4389 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D))
4390 return Match;
4391 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C))
4392 return Match;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004393 }
4394
4395 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4396 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4397 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4398 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
4399 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4400 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4401 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004402 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004403 SI1->getOperand(0),
4404 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004405 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004406 SI1->getOperand(1));
4407 }
4408 }
4409
4410 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4411 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
4412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
4413 } else {
4414 A = 0;
4415 }
4416 // Note, A is still live here!
4417 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4418 if (Op0 == B)
4419 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
4420
4421 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
4422 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004423 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004424 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004425 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004426 }
4427 }
4428
4429 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4430 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4431 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
4432 return R;
4433
4434 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4435 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4436 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4437 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4438 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4439 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4440 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4441 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4442 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4443 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4444 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4445 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4446 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
4447 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4448 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
4449 bool NeedsSwap;
Nick Lewycky5515c7a2008-09-30 06:08:34 +00004450 if (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) ? ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)
4451 : ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004452 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4453 else
4454 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4455
4456 if (NeedsSwap) {
4457 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4458 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4459 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4460 }
4461
4462 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4463 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4464 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4465 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4466 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4467 // equal.
4468 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4469
4470 switch (LHSCC) {
4471 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4472 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4473 switch (RHSCC) {
4474 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4475 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4476 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4477 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004478 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004479 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4480 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
4481 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
4482 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
4483 }
4484 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4485 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4486 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4487 break;
4488 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4489 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4492 }
4493 break;
4494 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4495 switch (RHSCC) {
4496 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4497 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4498 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4499 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4500 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4501 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4502 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4503 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4504 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4505 }
4506 break;
4507 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4508 switch (RHSCC) {
4509 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4510 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4511 break;
4512 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner26376862007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004513 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4514 // this can cause overflow.
4515 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4516 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004517 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4518 false, I);
4519 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4520 break;
4521 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4522 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4523 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4524 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4525 break;
4526 }
4527 break;
4528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4529 switch (RHSCC) {
4530 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4532 break;
4533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner26376862007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004534 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4535 // this can cause overflow.
4536 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4537 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004538 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4539 false, I);
4540 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4541 break;
4542 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4543 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4546 break;
4547 }
4548 break;
4549 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4550 switch (RHSCC) {
4551 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4552 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4553 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4554 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4555 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4556 break;
4557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4561 break;
4562 }
4563 break;
4564 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4565 switch (RHSCC) {
4566 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4567 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4569 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4570 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4571 break;
4572 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4573 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4574 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4575 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4576 break;
4577 }
4578 break;
4579 }
4580 }
4581 }
4582
4583 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004584 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004585 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4586 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004587 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4588 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4589 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4590 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4591 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4592 // generated.
4593 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4594 I.getType(), TD) &&
4595 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4596 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004597 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004598 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4599 I.getName());
4600 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004601 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004602 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004603 }
4604 }
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004605 }
4606
4607
4608 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4609 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4610 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4611 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattnerbe9e63e2008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004612 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng72988052008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004613 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004614 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4615 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4616 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4617 // true.
Chris Lattnera6c7dce2007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004618 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004619 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4620
4621 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4622 // rest.
4623 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4624 RHS->getOperand(0));
4625 }
Evan Cheng72988052008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004626 } else {
4627 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4628 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4629 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4630 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
4631 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4632 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4633 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4634 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4635 }
4636 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4637 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4638 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4639 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4640 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4641 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4642 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4643 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4645 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4646 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4647 bool Op0Ordered;
4648 bool Op1Ordered;
4649 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4650 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4651 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4652 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4653 // or'ed predicates.
4654 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4655 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4656 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4657 return I;
4658 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4659 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4660 }
4661 }
4662 }
4663 }
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004664 }
4665 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004666
4667 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4668}
4669
Dan Gohman089efff2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004670namespace {
4671
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004672// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4673struct XorSelf {
4674 Value *RHS;
4675 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4676 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4677 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4678 return &Xor;
4679 }
4680};
4681
Dan Gohman089efff2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004682}
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004683
4684Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
4685 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
4686 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4687
Evan Chenge5cd8032008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004688 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4689 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4690 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4691 // idiom (misuse).
4692 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004693 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chenge5cd8032008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004694 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004695
4696 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4697 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerb933ea62007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004698 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
4700 }
4701
4702 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4703 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
4704 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4705 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4706 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4707 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4708 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4709 return &I;
4710 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
4712 }
4713
4714 // Is this a ~ operation?
4715 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4716 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4717 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4718 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4719 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4720 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4721 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4722 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4723 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004724 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004725 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4726 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4727 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004728 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004729 else
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004730 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004731 }
4732 }
4733 }
4734 }
4735
4736
4737 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky1405e922007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004738 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4739 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4740 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004741 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4742 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
4743
Nick Lewycky1405e922007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004744 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4745 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4746 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4747 }
4748
Nick Lewycky0aa63aa2008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004749 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4750 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4751 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4752 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4753 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4754 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4755 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4756 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4757 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4758 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4759 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4760 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4761 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4762 }
4763 }
4764 }
4765 }
4766 }
4767
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004768 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
4769 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
4770 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4771 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4772 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4773 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
4774 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004775 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004776 }
4777
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004778 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004779 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
4780 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
4781 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
4782 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004783 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004784 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
4785 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
4786 Op0I->getOperand(0));
4787 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
4788 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4789 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004790 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004791
4792 }
4793 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4794 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
4795 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
4796 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4797 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4798 // NewRHS.
4799 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
4800 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4801 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
4802 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
4803 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4804 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4805 return &I;
4806 }
4807 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004808 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004809 }
4810
4811 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4812 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
4813 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
4814 return R;
4815 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4816 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4817 return NV;
4818 }
4819
4820 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
4821 if (X == Op1)
4822 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
4823
4824 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
4825 if (X == Op0)
4826 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
4827
4828
4829 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4830 if (Op1I) {
4831 Value *A, *B;
4832 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4833 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
4834 Op1I->swapOperands();
4835 I.swapOperands();
4836 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4837 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
4838 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4839 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4840 }
4841 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4842 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4843 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4844 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4845 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4846 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
4847 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
4848 Op1I->swapOperands();
4849 std::swap(A, B);
4850 }
4851 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
4852 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4853 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4854 }
4855 }
4856 }
4857
4858 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4859 if (Op0I) {
4860 Value *A, *B;
4861 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4862 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4863 std::swap(A, B);
4864 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4865 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004866 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4867 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004868 }
4869 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4870 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4872 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4873 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4874 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4875 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4876 std::swap(A, B);
4877 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
4878 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
4879 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004880 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4881 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004882 }
4883 }
4884 }
4885
4886 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4887 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4888 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4889 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4890 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4891 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004892 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004893 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4894 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004895 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004896 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4897 }
4898
4899 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4900 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4901 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4902 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4903 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4904 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004905 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004906 }
4907 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4908 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4909 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4910 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004911 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004912 }
4913
4914 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4915 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4916 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4917 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4918 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4919 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4920 if (A == C)
4921 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4922 else if (A == D)
4923 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4924 else if (B == C)
4925 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4926 else if (B == D)
4927 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4928
4929 if (X) {
4930 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004931 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4932 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004933 }
4934 }
4935 }
4936
4937 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4938 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4939 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
4940 return R;
4941
4942 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004943 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004944 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4945 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4946 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4947 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4948 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
4949 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4950 I.getType(), TD) &&
4951 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4952 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004953 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004954 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4955 I.getName());
4956 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004957 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004958 }
4959 }
Chris Lattner91882432007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004960 }
Nick Lewycky0aa63aa2008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004961
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004962 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4963}
4964
4965/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4966/// overflowed for this type.
4967static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
4968 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
4969 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
4970
4971 if (IsSigned)
4972 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4973 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4974 else
4975 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4976 else
4977 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
4978}
4979
Dan Gohmanb80d5612008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004980/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
4981/// overflowed for this type.
4982static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
4983 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohman2c3b4892008-09-11 18:53:02 +00004984 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohmanb80d5612008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004985
4986 if (IsSigned)
4987 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4988 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4989 else
4990 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4991 else
4992 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
4993}
4994
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00004995/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4996/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4997/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4998static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4999 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5000 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5001 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5002 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
5003
5004 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattnereba75862008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005005 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005006 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5007
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005008 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5009 ++i, ++GTI) {
5010 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +00005011 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005012 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5013 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5014
5015 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5016 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5017 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5018
5019 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
5020 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
5021 else
5022 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005023 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005024 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5025 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5026 continue;
5027 }
5028
5029 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5030 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5031 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
5032 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5033 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
5034 else {
5035 // Emit an add instruction.
5036 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005037 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005038 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5039 }
5040 continue;
5041 }
5042 // Convert to correct type.
5043 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5044 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5045 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
5046 else
5047 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
5048 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
5049 }
5050 if (Size != 1) {
5051 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5052 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5053 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
5054 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005055 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005056 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5057 }
5058
5059 // Emit an add instruction.
5060 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
5061 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
5062 cast<Constant>(Result));
5063 else
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005064 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005065 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5066 }
5067 return Result;
5068}
5069
Chris Lattnereba75862008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005070
5071/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
5072/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
5073/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
5074/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
5075/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
5076/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
5077/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
5078///
5079/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5080///
5081static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5082 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattnereba75862008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005083 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5084 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5085
5086 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5087 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5088 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5089 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5090 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5091 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5092 int64_t Offset = 0;
5093 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5094 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5095 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5096 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5097
5098 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5099 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5100 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5101 } else {
5102 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5103 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5104 }
5105 } else {
5106 // Found our variable index.
5107 break;
5108 }
5109 }
5110
5111 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5112 // evaluate it the general way.
5113 if (i == e) return 0;
5114
5115 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5116 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5117 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
5118 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5119
5120 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5121 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5122 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5123 if (!CI) return 0;
5124
5125 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5126 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5127
5128 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5129 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5130 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5131 } else {
5132 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5133 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5134 }
5135 }
5136
5137 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5138 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5139 // the index.
5140 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5141 if (Offset == 0) {
5142 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5143 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5144 // computation crosses zero.
5145 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5146 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5147 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5148 return VariableIdx;
5149 }
5150
5151 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5152 // the pointer size, so get it.
5153 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5154
5155 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5156 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5157
5158 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5159 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5160 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5161 // multiple of the variable scale.
5162 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5163 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5164 return 0;
5165
5166 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5167 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5168 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005169 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattnereba75862008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005170 true /*SExt*/,
5171 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5172 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005173 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattnereba75862008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005174}
5175
5176
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005177/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
5178/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
5179Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5180 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5181 Instruction &I) {
5182 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
5183
Chris Lattnereba75862008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005184 // Look through bitcasts.
5185 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5186 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005187
5188 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5189 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattneraf97d022008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005190 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattnereba75862008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005191 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5192 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5193 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5194
5195 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5196 if (Offset == 0)
5197 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattneraf97d022008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005198 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
5199 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005200 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
5201 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5202 // compare the base pointer.
5203 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5204 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
5205 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
5206 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
5207 if (IndicesTheSame)
5208 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5209 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5210 IndicesTheSame = false;
5211 break;
5212 }
5213
5214 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5215 if (IndicesTheSame)
5216 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5217 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
5218
5219 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5220 // different, bail out.
5221 return 0;
5222 }
5223
5224 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5225 bool AllZeros = true;
5226 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5227 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5228 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5229 AllZeros = false;
5230 break;
5231 }
5232 if (AllZeros)
5233 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5234 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
5235
5236 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
5237 AllZeros = true;
5238 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5239 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5240 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5241 AllZeros = false;
5242 break;
5243 }
5244 if (AllZeros)
5245 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
5246
5247 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5248 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5249 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5250 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5251 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5252 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5253 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5254 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
5255 // Irreconcilable differences.
5256 NumDifferences = 2;
5257 break;
5258 } else {
5259 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5260 DiffOperand = i;
5261 }
5262 }
5263
5264 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5265 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky2de09a92007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005266 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewycky09284cf2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005267 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky2de09a92007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005268
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005269 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
5270 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5271 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5272 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5273 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
5274 }
5275 }
5276
5277 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
5278 // the result to fold to a constant!
5279 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5280 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5281 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5282 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5283 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
5284 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
5285 }
5286 }
5287 return 0;
5288}
5289
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005290/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5291///
5292Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5293 Instruction *LHSI,
5294 Constant *RHSC) {
5295 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5296 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5297
5298 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5299 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner9ce836b2008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005300 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005301 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5302
5303 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5304 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5305 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5306 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5307
5308 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005309 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5310 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005311 ++InputSize;
5312
5313 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5314 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5315 return 0;
5316
5317 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5318 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5319 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5320 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5321
5322 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5323 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5324 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5325 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005326 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5327 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5328 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005329 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005330 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5331 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5332 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005333 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005334 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5335 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5336 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005337 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005338 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5339 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5340 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005341 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005342 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5343 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5344 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005345 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005346 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5347 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5348 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005349 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5351 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5353 }
5354
5355 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5356
5357 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5358
Chris Lattnerf13ff492008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005359 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005360 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5361 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5362
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005363 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5364 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5365 // and large values.
5366 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5367 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5368 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5369 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5370 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5371 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
5372 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5374 }
5375 } else {
5376 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5377 // +INF and large values.
5378 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5379 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5380 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5381 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5382 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5383 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
5384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5385 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5386 }
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005387 }
5388
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005389 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5390 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5391 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5392 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5393 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5394 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5395 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5396 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
5397 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5399 }
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005400 }
5401
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005402 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5403 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5404 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5405 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005406 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5407 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5408 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005409 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust the
5410 // compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards zero
5411 // at this point.
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005412 switch (Pred) {
5413 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5414 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5415 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5416 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5417 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005418 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5419 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5420 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5421 if (RHS.isNegative())
5422 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5423 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005424 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5425 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5426 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5427 if (RHS.isNegative())
5428 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5429 break;
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005430 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5431 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5432 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5433 if (RHS.isNegative())
5434 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5435 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5436 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005437 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5438 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5439 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5440 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5441 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5442 break;
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005443 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5444 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5445 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5446 if (RHS.isNegative())
5447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5448 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005449 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5450 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5451 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5452 if (RHS.isNegative())
5453 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5454 break;
Bill Wendling20636df2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005455 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5456 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5457 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5458 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5460 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5461 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005462 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5463 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5464 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5465 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5466 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5467 break;
5468 }
5469 }
5470
5471 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5472 // comparison.
5473 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5474}
5475
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005476Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5477 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5478 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5479
5480 // Fold trivial predicates.
5481 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5483 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5485
5486 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5487 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5488 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5489 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5490 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5491 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5492 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5493 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5494 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5495 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5496 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5498
5499 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5500 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5501 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5502 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5503 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5504 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5505 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5506 return &I;
5507
5508 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5509 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5510 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5511 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5512 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5513 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5514 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5515 return &I;
5516 }
5517 }
5518
5519 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
5520 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
5521
5522 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5523 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005524 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5525 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5526 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5527 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerf13ff492008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005529 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5530 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5531 // True if unordered.
5532 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005533 }
5534 }
5535
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005536 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5537 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5538 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattnera2417ba2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005539 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5540 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5541 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5542 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5543 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5544 return NV;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005545 break;
Chris Lattnere6b62d92008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005546 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5547 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5548 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5549 return NV;
5550 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005551 case Instruction::Select:
5552 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5553 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5554 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5555 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5556 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5557 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5558 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5559 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5560 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5561 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5562 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5563 I.getName()), I);
5564 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5565 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5566 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5567 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5568 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5569 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5570 I.getName()), I);
5571 }
5572 }
5573
5574 if (Op1)
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005575 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005576 break;
5577 }
5578 }
5579
5580 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5581}
5582
5583Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5584 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5585 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5586 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5587
5588 // icmp X, X
5589 if (Op0 == Op1)
5590 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewycky09284cf2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005591 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005592
5593 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
5594 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lambf78cd322007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005595
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005596 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
5597 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
5598 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5599 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5600 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
5601 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
5602 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewycky09284cf2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005603 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005604
5605 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
5606 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
5607 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5608 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattnera02893d2008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005609 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005610 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005611 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005612 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005613 }
Chris Lattnera02893d2008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005614 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005615 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005616
5617 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattnera02893d2008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005618 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005619 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattnera02893d2008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005621 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005622 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005623 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005624 }
Chris Lattnera02893d2008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005625 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5626 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005627 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattnera02893d2008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005628 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5629 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5630 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5631 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5632 }
5633 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5634 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5635 // FALL THROUGH
5636 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005637 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005638 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005639 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005640 }
Chris Lattnera02893d2008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005641 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5642 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5643 // FALL THROUGH
5644 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5645 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5646 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5647 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5648 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005649 }
5650 }
5651
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005652 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005653 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner3d816532008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005654 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lambfa6b3102007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005655
Chris Lattnerbe6c54a2008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005656 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5657 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5658 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5659 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5660 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Anderson42f61ed2007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005661 }
Christopher Lambfa6b3102007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005662
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005663 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5664 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5665 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005666 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5667 default: break;
5668 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5669 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5670 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5671 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5672 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5673 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5674 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5675 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5676 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5677 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5679 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5680 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5681 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5682 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5683 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5684 }
5685
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005686 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5687 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5688 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5689 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5690
5691 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005692 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005693 bool UnusedBit;
5694 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5695
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005696 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5697 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5698 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
5699 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5700 return &I;
5701
5702 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005703 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5704 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5705 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005706 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5707 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5708 else
5709 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5710
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005711 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5712 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5713 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5714 if (Min == Max)
5715 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5716 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5717 CI));
5718
5719 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5720 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5721 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005722 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5723 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5724 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5725 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5726 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5727 break;
5728 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5729 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5730 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5731 break;
5732 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005733 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005735 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005736 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005737 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5738 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5739 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5740 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5741
5742 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5743 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5744 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5745 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005746 break;
5747 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005748 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005749 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005750 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005752
5753 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5754 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5755 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5756 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5757
5758 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5759 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5760 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5761 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005762 break;
5763 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005764 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner611b43e2008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005766 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005767 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005768 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5769 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner3496f3e2008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005770 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattner55ab3152008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005771 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005772 break;
5773 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005774 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005775 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005776 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005777 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnera1308652008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005778
5779 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5780 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5781 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5782 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner62d0f232008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005783 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005784 }
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005785 }
5786
5787 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5788 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5789 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5790 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5791 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5792 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5793 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5794 if (I.hasOneUse())
5795 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5796 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5797 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5798 return 0;
5799
5800 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5801 // can be folded into the comparison.
5802 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005803 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
5804 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
5805 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
5806 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5807 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5808 return Res;
5809 }
5810
5811 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
5812 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5813 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5814 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5815 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5816 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
5817 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
5818 bool isAllZeros = true;
5819 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5820 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5821 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5822 isAllZeros = false;
5823 break;
5824 }
5825 if (isAllZeros)
5826 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
5827 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5828 }
5829 break;
5830
5831 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattnera2417ba2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005832 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5833 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5834 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5835 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5836 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5837 return NV;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005838 break;
5839 case Instruction::Select: {
5840 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5841 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5842 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5843 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5844 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5845 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5846 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5847 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5848 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5849 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5850 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5851 I.getName()), I);
5852 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5853 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5854 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5855 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5856 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5857 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5858 I.getName()), I);
5859 }
5860 }
5861
5862 if (Op1)
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005863 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005864 break;
5865 }
5866 case Instruction::Malloc:
5867 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5868 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5869 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5870 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewycky09284cf2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005872 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005873 }
5874 break;
5875 }
5876 }
5877
5878 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
5879 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
5880 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
5881 return NI;
5882 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
5883 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5884 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
5885 return NI;
5886
5887 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
5888 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5889 // now.
5890 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5891 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5892 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
5893 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5894 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
5895 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
5896
5897 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5898 // so eliminate it as well.
5899 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5900 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
5901
5902 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005903 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005904 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5905 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
5906 } else {
5907 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner13c2d6e2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005908 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005909 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005910 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005911 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
5912 }
5913 }
5914
5915 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5916 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
5917 // This comes up when you have code like
5918 // int X = A < B;
5919 // if (X) ...
5920 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
5921 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5922 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
5923 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
5924 return R;
5925 }
5926
Nick Lewyckyd4c5ea02008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005927 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5928 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5929 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky58ecfb22008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005930 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5931 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5932 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewyckycfadfbd2008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005933 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewyckyd4c5ea02008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005934 default: break;
5935 case Instruction::Add:
5936 case Instruction::Sub:
5937 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky58ecfb22008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005938 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5939 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5940 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewyckyd4c5ea02008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005941 break;
5942 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky58ecfb22008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005943 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5944 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5945 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5946 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5947 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5948 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5949 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5950 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewyckyd4c5ea02008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005951 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky58ecfb22008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005952 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5953 Mask);
5954 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5955 Mask);
5956 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5957 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5958 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewyckyd4c5ea02008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005959 }
5960 }
5961 break;
5962 }
5963 }
5964 }
5965 }
5966
Chris Lattnera4e1eef2008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005967 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5968 { Value *A, *B;
5969 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5970 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5971 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5972 }
5973
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005974 if (I.isEquality()) {
5975 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattnera4e1eef2008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005976
5977 // -x == -y --> x == y
5978 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5979 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5980 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5981
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005982 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5983 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5984 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5985 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5986 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5987 }
5988
5989 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5990 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5991 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5992 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5993 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
5994 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005995 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00005996 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5997 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5998 }
5999
6000 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
6001 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6002 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6003 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6004 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
6005 }
6006 }
6007
6008 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6009 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
6010 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6011 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
6012 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6013 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
6014 }
6015 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
6016 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
6017 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6018 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
6019 }
6020 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
6021 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
6022 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6023 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
6024 }
6025
6026 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6027 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
6028 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6029 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6030 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6031
6032 if (A == C) {
6033 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6034 } else if (A == D) {
6035 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6036 } else if (B == C) {
6037 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6038 } else if (B == D) {
6039 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6040 }
6041
6042 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006043 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
6044 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006045 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
6046 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
6047 return &I;
6048 }
6049 }
6050 }
6051 return Changed ? &I : 0;
6052}
6053
6054
6055/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6056/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6057Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6058 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6059 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6060 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6061
6062 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6063 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6064 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6065 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6066 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6067 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6068 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6069 // if it finds it.
6070 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6071 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6072 return 0;
6073 if (DivRHS->isZero())
6074 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnerbd85a5f2008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006075 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6076 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6077 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6078 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6079 // with INT_MIN.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006080
6081 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6082 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6083 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6084 // instead of computing a divide.
6085 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
6086
6087 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6088 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6089 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
6090 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6091 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
6092
6093 // Get the ICmp opcode
6094 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
6095
6096 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6097 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6098 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6099 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6100 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6101 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6102 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6103 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
6104 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
6105
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006106 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
6107 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6108 LoBound = Prod;
6109 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6110 if (!HiOverflow)
6111 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman5dceed12008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006112 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006113 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
6114 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
6115 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
6116 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman5dceed12008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006117 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006118 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6119 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6120 if (!HiOverflow)
6121 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
6122 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
6123 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006124 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnerbd85a5f2008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006125 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6126 if (!LoOverflow) {
6127 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6128 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
6129 true) ? -1 : 0;
6130 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006131 }
Dan Gohman5dceed12008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006132 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006133 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
6134 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
6135 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
6136 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6137 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6138 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6139 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6140 }
Dan Gohman5dceed12008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006141 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006142 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnerbd85a5f2008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006143 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006144 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6145 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnerbd85a5f2008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006146 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006147 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnerbd85a5f2008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006148 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6149 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman45408ea2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006150 if (!HiOverflow)
6151 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006152 }
6153
6154 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6155 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
6156 }
6157
6158 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
6159 switch (Pred) {
6160 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
6161 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6162 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6164 else if (HiOverflow)
6165 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6166 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6167 else if (LoOverflow)
6168 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6169 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6170 else
6171 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
6172 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6173 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6174 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6175 else if (HiOverflow)
6176 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6177 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6178 else if (LoOverflow)
6179 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6180 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6181 else
6182 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
6183 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6184 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
6185 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
6186 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6187 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
6188 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6189 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
6190 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6191 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6192 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
6193 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6194 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
6195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6196 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
6197 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6198 else
6199 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
6200 }
6201}
6202
6203
6204/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6205///
6206Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6207 Instruction *LHSI,
6208 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6209 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6210
6211 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
6212 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
6213 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6214 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6215 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006216 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6217 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006218 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6219
6220 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6221 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6222 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6223 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6224 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6225 return &ICI;
6226 }
6227
6228 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6229 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6230
6231 // If so, the new one isn't.
6232 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6233
6234 if (isTrueIfPositive)
6235 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
6236 else
6237 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
6238 }
6239 }
6240 break;
6241 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6242 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6243 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6244 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6245
6246 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6247 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6248 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6249 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6250 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6251 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6252 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6253 // bit would not work.
6254 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov6a4a9332008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006255 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6256 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006257 uint32_t BitWidth =
6258 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6259 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6260 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6261 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6262 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6263 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006264 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006265 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
6266 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6267 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6268 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6269 }
6270 }
6271
6272 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6273 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6274 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6275 // access.
6276 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6277 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6278 Shift = 0;
6279
6280 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6281 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6282 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6283 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6284
6285 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6286 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6287 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6288 if (ShAmt) {
6289 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6290 if (!CanFold) {
6291 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6292 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6293 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6294 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6295
6296 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6297 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6298 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6299 CanFold = true;
6300 }
6301
6302 if (CanFold) {
6303 Constant *NewCst;
6304 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6305 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6306 else
6307 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6308
6309 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6310 // compared.
6311 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6312 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6313 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6314 // result is always true or false now.
6315 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6316 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6317 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6318 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6319 } else {
6320 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6321 Constant *NewAndCST;
6322 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6323 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6324 else
6325 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6326 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6327 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6328 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6329 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6330 return &ICI;
6331 }
6332 }
6333 }
6334
6335 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6336 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6337 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6338 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6339 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6340 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6341 // Compute C << Y.
6342 Value *NS;
6343 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006344 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006345 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6346 } else {
6347 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006348 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006349 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6350 }
6351 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6352
6353 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6354 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006355 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006356 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6357
6358 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6359 return &ICI;
6360 }
6361 }
6362 break;
6363
6364 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6365 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6366 if (!ShAmt) break;
6367
6368 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6369
6370 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6371 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6372 // simplified.
6373 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6374 break;
6375
6376 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6377 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6378 // comparison cannot succeed.
6379 Constant *Comp =
6380 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6381 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6382 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6383 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6385 }
6386
6387 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6388 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6389 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6390 Constant *Mask =
6391 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
6392
6393 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006394 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006395 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6396 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6397 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6398 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
6399 }
6400 }
6401
6402 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6403 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6404 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6405 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6406 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6407 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6408 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6409 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006410 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006411 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6412 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6413
6414 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6415 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6416 }
6417 break;
6418 }
6419
6420 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
6421 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner5ee84f82008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006422 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006423 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner5ee84f82008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006424 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006425
Chris Lattner5ee84f82008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006426 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6427 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6428 // simplified.
6429 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6430 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6431 break;
6432
6433 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006434
Chris Lattner5ee84f82008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006435 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6436 // comparison cannot succeed.
6437 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6438 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6439 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6440 else
6441 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6442
6443 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6444 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6445 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6446 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6447 }
6448
6449 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6450 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6451 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengfb9292a2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006452 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6453 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner5ee84f82008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006454 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6455 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6456 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6457 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006458
Evan Chengfb9292a2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006459 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner5ee84f82008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006460 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6461 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6462 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006463
Chris Lattner5ee84f82008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006464 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006465 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner5ee84f82008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006466 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6467 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6468 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6469 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006470 }
6471 break;
6472 }
6473
6474 case Instruction::SDiv:
6475 case Instruction::UDiv:
6476 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6477 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6478 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6479 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6480 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6481 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
6482 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6483 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6484 DivRHS))
6485 return R;
6486 break;
Nick Lewycky0185bbf2008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006487
6488 case Instruction::Add:
6489 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6490
6491 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6492 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6493 if (!LHSC) break;
6494 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6495
6496 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6497 .subtract(LHSV);
6498
6499 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6500 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6501 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6502 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6503 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6504 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6505 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6506 }
6507 } else {
6508 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6509 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6510 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6511 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6512 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6513 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6514 }
6515 }
6516 }
6517 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006518 }
6519
6520 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6521 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6522 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6523
6524 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6525 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6526 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6527 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6528 case Instruction::SRem:
6529 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6530 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6531 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6532 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6533 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006534 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006535 BO->getName());
6536 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6537 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6538 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6539 }
6540 }
6541 break;
6542 case Instruction::Add:
6543 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6544 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6545 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6546 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6547 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6548 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6549 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6550 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6551 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6552
6553 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6554 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6555 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6556 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6557 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006558 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006559 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6560 Neg->takeName(BO);
6561 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6562 }
6563 }
6564 break;
6565 case Instruction::Xor:
6566 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6567 // the explicit xor.
6568 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6569 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6570 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6571
6572 // FALLTHROUGH
6573 case Instruction::Sub:
6574 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6575 if (RHSV == 0)
6576 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6577 BO->getOperand(1));
6578 break;
6579
6580 case Instruction::Or:
6581 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6582 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6583 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6584 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6585 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6587 isICMP_NE));
6588 }
6589 break;
6590
6591 case Instruction::And:
6592 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6593 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6594 // comparison can never succeed!
6595 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6596 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6597 isICMP_NE));
6598
6599 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6600 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6601 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6602 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6603 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6604
6605 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner60813c22008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006606 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006607 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6608 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6609 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6610 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6611 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6612 }
6613
6614 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6615 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6616 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6617 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6618 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6619 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6620 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6621 }
6622 }
6623 default: break;
6624 }
6625 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6626 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6627 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6628 AddToWorkList(II);
6629 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6630 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6631 return &ICI;
6632 }
6633 }
6634 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
6635 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6636 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
6637 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6638 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6639 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6640 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6641 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6642 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6643 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6644 // smaller constant values.
6645 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6646 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6647 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6648 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6649 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6650 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6651 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6652 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6653 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6654 }
6655 }
6656 }
6657 }
6658 return 0;
6659}
6660
6661/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6662/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6663///
6664Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6665 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
6666 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6667 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
6668 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
6669 Value *RHSCIOp;
6670
6671 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6672 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6673 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6674 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6675 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6676 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6677 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6678 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
6679 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6680 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6681 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6682 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner13c2d6e2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006683 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006684 }
6685
6686 if (RHSOp)
6687 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6688 }
6689
6690 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6691 // Enforce this.
6692 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6693 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
6694 return 0;
6695
6696 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6697 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
6698
6699 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6700 // Not an extension from the same type?
6701 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
6702 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6703 return 0;
6704
Nick Lewyckyd4264dc2008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006705 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006706 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6707 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6708 return 0;
6709
Nick Lewyckyd4264dc2008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006710 // Deal with equality cases early.
6711 if (ICI.isEquality())
6712 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6713
6714 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6715 // signed comparison.
6716 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6717 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6718
6719 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6720 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006721 }
6722
6723 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6724 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6725 if (!CI)
6726 return 0;
6727
6728 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6729 // reextended to DestTy.
6730 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6731 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6732
6733 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6734 if (Res2 == CI) {
6735 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6736 // For example, we might have:
6737 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6738 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6739 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6740 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6741 // because %A may have negative value.
6742 //
Chris Lattner3d816532008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006743 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6744 // signless.
6745 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006746 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattner3d816532008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006747 return 0;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006748 }
6749
6750 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6751 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6752
6753 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6754 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6755 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6757 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6758 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6759
6760 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6761 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6762 Value *Result;
6763 if (isSignedCmp) {
6764 // We're performing a signed comparison.
6765 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
6766 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
6767 else
6768 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
6769 } else {
6770 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6771 if (isSignedExt) {
6772 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6773 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
6774 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
6775 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6776 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6777 } else {
6778 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
6779 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
6780 }
6781 }
6782
6783 // Finally, return the value computed.
6784 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattner3d816532008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006785 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattner3d816532008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006787
6788 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6789 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6790 "ICmp should be folded!");
6791 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6793 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006794}
6795
6796Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6797 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6798}
6799
6800Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6801 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6802}
6803
6804Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnere3c504f2007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006805 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6806 return R;
6807
6808 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6809
6810 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6811 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6812 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6813 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6814
6815 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begemanbb1ce942008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006816 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6817 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattnere3c504f2007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006818 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006819 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere3c504f2007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006820
6821 return 0;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006822}
6823
6824Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6825 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
6826 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
6827
6828 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6829 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
6830 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
6831 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6833
6834 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6835 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
6836 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6837 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
6838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6839 }
6840 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
6841 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6842 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6843 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
6844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6845 }
6846
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006847 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6848 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6849 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
6850 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6851 return R;
6852
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006853 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
6854 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6855 return Res;
6856 return 0;
6857}
6858
6859Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
6860 BinaryOperator &I) {
6861 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
6862
6863 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6864 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
6865 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6866 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6867 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
6868 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6869 return &I;
6870
6871 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6872 // of a signed value.
6873 //
6874 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
6875 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
6876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6877 else {
6878 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
6879 return &I;
6880 }
6881 }
6882
6883 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6884 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6885 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6886 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006887 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006888 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6889
6890 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6891 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6892 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6893 return R;
6894 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6895 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6896 return NV;
6897
Chris Lattnerc6d1f642007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006898 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6899 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6900 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6901 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6902 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6903 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6904 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6905 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6906 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6907 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6908 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6909 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006910 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattnerc6d1f642007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006911 I.getName());
6912 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6913
6914 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6915 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6916 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6917 // other xforms later if dead.
6918 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6919 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6920 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6921
6922 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6923 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6924 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6925 // mask as appropriate.
6926 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6927 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6928 else {
6929 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6930 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6931 }
6932
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006933 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattnerc6d1f642007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006934 TI->getName());
6935 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6936
6937 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6938 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6939 }
6940 }
6941
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006942 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
6943 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6944 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6945 Value *V1, *V2;
6946 ConstantInt *CC;
6947 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
6948 default: break;
6949 case Instruction::Add:
6950 case Instruction::And:
6951 case Instruction::Or:
6952 case Instruction::Xor: {
6953 // These operators commute.
6954 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6955 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6956 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
6957 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006958 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006959 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6960 Op0BO->getName());
6961 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6962 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006963 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006964 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
6965 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
6966 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006967 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006968 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
6969 }
6970
6971 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
6972 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
6973 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
6974 match(Op0BOOp1,
6975 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
6976 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6977 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006978 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006979 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6980 Op0BO->getName());
6981 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6982 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006983 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006984 V1->getName()+".mask");
6985 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6986
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006987 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006988 }
6989 }
6990
6991 // FALL THROUGH.
6992 case Instruction::Sub: {
6993 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6994 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6995 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6996 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006997 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00006998 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6999 Op0BO->getName());
7000 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7001 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007002 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007003 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
7004 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
7005 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007006 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007007 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
7008 }
7009
7010 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
7011 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7012 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7013 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
7014 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
7015 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7016 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007017 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007018 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7019 Op0BO->getName());
7020 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7021 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007022 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007023 V1->getName()+".mask");
7024 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7025
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007026 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007027 }
7028
7029 break;
7030 }
7031 }
7032
7033
7034 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7035 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7036 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7037 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7038 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7039
7040 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
7041 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
7042 case Instruction::Add:
7043 isValid = isLeftShift;
7044 break;
7045 case Instruction::Or:
7046 case Instruction::Xor:
7047 highBitSet = false;
7048 break;
7049 case Instruction::And:
7050 highBitSet = true;
7051 break;
7052 }
7053
7054 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7055 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7056 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7057 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7058 // operation.
7059 //
Chris Lattner15b76e32007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007060 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007061 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007062
7063 if (isValid) {
7064 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
7065
7066 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007067 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007068 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
7069 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
7070
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007071 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007072 NewRHS);
7073 }
7074 }
7075 }
7076 }
7077
7078 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
7079 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7080 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7081 ShiftOp = 0;
7082
7083 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
7084 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
7085 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7086 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7087 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7088 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7089 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
7090
7091 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
7092 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
7093 AmtSum = TypeBits;
7094
7095 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7096
7097 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
7098 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007099 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007100 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
7101 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7102 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
7103 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007104 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007105 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7106 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7107 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
7108 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007109 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007110 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7111
7112 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007113 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007114 }
7115
7116 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7117 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7118 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7119 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7120 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7121 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007122 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007123 }
7124 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7125 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7126 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007127 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007128 }
7129 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7130 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7131 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7132 // generators.
7133 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7134 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
7135 case 1 :
7136 case 8 :
7137 case 16 :
7138 case 32 :
7139 case 64 :
7140 case 128:
7141 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
7142 break;
7143 default: break;
7144 }
7145 if (SExtType) {
7146 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7147 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7148 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7149 }
7150 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7151 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
7152 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
7153
7154 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
7155 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7156 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7157 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7158 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007159 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007160 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7161
7162 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007163 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007164 }
7165
7166 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
7167 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7168 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7169 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007170 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007171 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7172
7173 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007174 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007175 }
7176
7177 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7178 } else {
7179 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
7180 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
7181
7182 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
7183 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7184 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7185 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7186 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007187 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007188 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
7189 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7190
7191 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007192 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007193 }
7194
7195 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
7196 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7197 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7198 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007199 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007200 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7201
7202 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007203 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007204 }
7205
7206 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7207 }
7208 }
7209 return 0;
7210}
7211
7212
7213/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7214/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7215/// X*Scale+Offset.
7216///
7217static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
7218 int &Offset) {
7219 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
7220 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
7221 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc59171a2007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007222 Scale = 0;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007223 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattnerc59171a2007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007224 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7225 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7226 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7227 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7228 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7229 Offset = 0;
7230 return I->getOperand(0);
7231 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7232 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7233 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7234 Offset = 0;
7235 return I->getOperand(0);
7236 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7237 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7238 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7239 unsigned SubScale;
7240 Value *SubVal =
7241 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
7242 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7243 Scale = SubScale;
7244 return SubVal;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007245 }
7246 }
7247 }
7248
7249 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7250 Scale = 1;
7251 Offset = 0;
7252 return Val;
7253}
7254
7255
7256/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7257/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
7258Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
7259 AllocationInst &AI) {
7260 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
7261
7262 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7263 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
7264
7265 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7266 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7267 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7268 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7269 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7270
7271 ++NumDeadInst;
7272 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
7273 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
7274 }
7275 }
7276
7277 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7278 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7279 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7280 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
7281
7282 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7283 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
7284 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7285
7286 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7287 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7288 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7289 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7290
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007291 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
7292 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007293 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
7294
7295 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7296 // size argument.
7297 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7298 int ArrayOffset;
7299 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7300 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7301
7302 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7303 // do the xform.
7304 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7305 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
7306
7307 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7308 Value *Amt = 0;
7309 if (Scale == 1) {
7310 Amt = NumElements;
7311 } else {
7312 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
7313 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7314 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
7315 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
7316 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
7317 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007318 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007319 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7320 }
7321 }
7322
7323 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7324 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007325 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007326 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7327 }
7328
7329 AllocationInst *New;
7330 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
7331 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
7332 else
7333 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
7334 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
7335 New->takeName(&AI);
7336
7337 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7338 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7339 // die soon.
7340 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7341 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
7342 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7343 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7344 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
7345 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7346 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7347 }
7348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7349}
7350
7351/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
7352/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7353/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7354/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7355/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7356///
7357/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7358/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner4200c2062008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007359///
7360/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7361/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7362/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7363/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7364/// efficiently truncated.
7365///
7366/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7367/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7368/// the final result.
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007369bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7370 unsigned CastOpc,
7371 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007372 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7373 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7374 return true;
7375
7376 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
7377 if (!I) return false;
7378
7379 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
7380
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007381 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7382 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7383 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7384 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7385 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7386 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7387 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7388 // casts first.
Chris Lattner4200c2062008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007389 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007390 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7391 return true;
7392 }
7393 }
7394
7395 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7396 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7397 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7398
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007399 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7400 case Instruction::Add:
7401 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewycky1265a7d2008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007402 case Instruction::Mul:
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007403 case Instruction::And:
7404 case Instruction::Or:
7405 case Instruction::Xor:
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007406 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007407 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7408 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7409 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7410 NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007411
7412 case Instruction::Shl:
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007413 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7414 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7415 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7416 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7417 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7418 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007419 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7420 NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007421 }
7422 break;
7423 case Instruction::LShr:
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007424 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7425 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7426 // already zeros.
7427 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7428 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7429 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7430 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
7431 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
7432 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7433 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007434 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7435 NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007436 }
7437 }
7438 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007439 case Instruction::ZExt:
7440 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007441 case Instruction::Trunc:
7442 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner9c909d22007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007443 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7444 // of casts in the input.
7445 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007446 return true;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007447 break;
Nick Lewycky1265a7d2008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007448 case Instruction::Select: {
7449 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7450 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7451 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7452 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7453 NumCastsRemoved);
7454 }
Chris Lattner4200c2062008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007455 case Instruction::PHI: {
7456 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7457 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7458 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7459 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7460 NumCastsRemoved))
7461 return false;
7462 return true;
7463 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007464 default:
7465 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7466 break;
7467 }
7468
7469 return false;
7470}
7471
7472/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7473/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7474/// evaluate the expression.
7475Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
7476 bool isSigned) {
7477 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
7478 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
7479
7480 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7481 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
7482 Instruction *Res = 0;
7483 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7484 case Instruction::Add:
7485 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyc52646a2008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007486 case Instruction::Mul:
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007487 case Instruction::And:
7488 case Instruction::Or:
7489 case Instruction::Xor:
7490 case Instruction::AShr:
7491 case Instruction::LShr:
7492 case Instruction::Shl: {
7493 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
7494 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007495 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner4200c2062008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007496 LHS, RHS);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007497 break;
7498 }
7499 case Instruction::Trunc:
7500 case Instruction::ZExt:
7501 case Instruction::SExt:
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007502 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007503 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7504 // new.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007505 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7506 return I->getOperand(0);
7507
Chris Lattner4200c2062008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007508 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007509 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4200c2062008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007510 Ty);
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007511 break;
Nick Lewycky1265a7d2008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007512 case Instruction::Select: {
7513 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7514 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7515 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7516 break;
7517 }
Chris Lattner4200c2062008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007518 case Instruction::PHI: {
7519 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7520 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7521 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7522 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7523 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7524 }
7525 Res = NPN;
7526 break;
7527 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007528 default:
7529 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7530 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7531 break;
7532 }
7533
Chris Lattner4200c2062008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007534 Res->takeName(I);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007535 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7536}
7537
7538/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7539Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7540 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7541
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007542 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
7543 // eliminate it now.
7544 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
7545 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7546 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7547 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7548 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007549 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007550 }
7551 }
7552
7553 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
7554 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7555 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7556 return NV;
7557
7558 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
7559 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7560 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7561 return NV;
7562
7563 return 0;
7564}
7565
7566/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7567Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7568 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7569
7570 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
7571 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7572 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
7573 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7574 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7575 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7576 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
7577 AddToWorkList(GEP);
7578 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7579 return &CI;
7580 }
7581
7582 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7583 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7584 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7585 // non-type-safe code.
7586 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7587 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7588 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7589 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7590 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7591
7592 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7593 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7594 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7595 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7596 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7597 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7598
7599 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7600 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7601 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
7602 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
7603 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007604 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007605 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7606 Offset %= TySize;
7607
7608 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7609 if (Offset < 0) {
7610 --FirstIdx;
7611 Offset += TySize;
7612 assert(Offset >= 0);
7613 }
7614 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
7615 }
7616
7617 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
7618
7619 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7620 while (Offset) {
7621 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7622 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
7623 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7624 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7625 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
7626
7627 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7628 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7629 } else {
7630 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7631 Offset = 0;
7632 OrigBase = 0;
7633 }
7634 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7635 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007636 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007637 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7638 Offset %= EltSize;
7639 } else {
7640 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7641 }
7642 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7643 } else {
7644 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7645 Offset = 0;
7646 OrigBase = 0;
7647 }
7648 }
7649 if (OrigBase) {
7650 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7651 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7652 // two.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007653 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7654 NewIndices.begin(),
7655 NewIndices.end(), "");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007656 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7657 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7658
7659 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7660 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7661 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7662 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7663 }
7664 }
7665 }
7666 }
7667 }
7668
7669 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7670}
7671
7672
7673
7674/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7675/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
7676/// cases.
7677/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7678Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7679 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7680 return Result;
7681
7682 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7683 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7684 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7685 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7686 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7687
7688 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7689 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
7690 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7691 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
7692 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7693 return &CI;
7694
7695 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7696 // can't do anything more.
7697 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7698 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
7699 return 0;
7700
7701 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
7702 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
7703 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7704 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007705 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007706 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattneref70bb82007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007707 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7708 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7709 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7710 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007711 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
7712 bool DoXForm;
7713 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7714 default:
7715 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7716 // get here because of the check above.
7717 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7718 case Instruction::Trunc:
7719 DoXForm = true;
7720 break;
7721 case Instruction::ZExt:
7722 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7723 break;
7724 case Instruction::SExt:
7725 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7726 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007727 }
7728
7729 if (DoXForm) {
7730 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7731 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
7732 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7733 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7734 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7735 case Instruction::Trunc:
7736 case Instruction::BitCast:
7737 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7738 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7739 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7740 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7741 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
7742 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7743 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007744 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007745 }
7746 case Instruction::SExt:
7747 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007748 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007749 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7750 CI), DestTy);
7751 }
7752 }
7753 }
7754
7755 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7756 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7757
7758 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7759 case Instruction::Add:
7760 case Instruction::Mul:
7761 case Instruction::And:
7762 case Instruction::Or:
7763 case Instruction::Xor:
7764 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
7765 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7766 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7767 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7768 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7769 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7770 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7771 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
7772 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
7773 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7774 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007775 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007776 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7777 }
7778 }
7779
7780 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7781 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7782 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
7783 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
7784 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
7785 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007786 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007787 }
7788 break;
7789 case Instruction::SDiv:
7790 case Instruction::UDiv:
7791 case Instruction::SRem:
7792 case Instruction::URem:
7793 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7794 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7795 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7796 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7797 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7798 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7799 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
7800 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7801 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7802 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7803 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007804 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007805 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7806 }
7807 }
7808 break;
7809
7810 case Instruction::Shl:
7811 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7812 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7813 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7814 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7815 // in the value.
7816 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7817 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
7818 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7819 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7820 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7821 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007822 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007823 }
7824 break;
7825 case Instruction::AShr:
7826 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7827 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7828 // simplifications.
7829 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7830 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
7831 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
7832 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7833 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007834 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007835 }
7836 }
7837 break;
7838 }
7839 return 0;
7840}
7841
7842Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
7843 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7844 return Result;
7845
7846 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7847 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
7848 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7849 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
7850
7851 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7852 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7853 default: break;
7854 case Instruction::LShr:
7855 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7856 // are already zeros.
7857 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
7858 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
7859
7860 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
7861 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
7862 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7863 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
7864 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7866
7867 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7868 // shift.
7869 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7870 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7871 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007872 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007873 }
7874 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7875
7876 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7877 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7878 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
7879 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
7880 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7881
7882 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007883 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007884 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007885 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007886 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7887 "tmp"), CI);
7888 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
7889 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
7890 }
7891 }
7892 break;
7893 }
7894 }
7895
7896 return 0;
7897}
7898
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007899/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7900/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7901Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7902 bool DoXform) {
7903 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7904 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7905 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7906 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7907 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7908
7909 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7910 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7911 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7912 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7913 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7914
7915 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7916 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7917 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007918 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007919 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7920 CI);
7921 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007922 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007923 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7924
7925 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7926 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007927 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007928 In->getName()+".not"),
7929 CI);
7930 }
7931
7932 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7933 }
7934
7935
7936
7937 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7938 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7939 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7940 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7941 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7942 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7943 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7944 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7945 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7946 // This only works for EQ and NE
7947 ICI->isEquality()) {
7948 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7949 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7950 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7951 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7952 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7953
7954 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7955 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7956 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7957
7958 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7959 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7960 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7961 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7962 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7963 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7964 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7965 }
7966
7967 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7968 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7969 if (ShiftAmt) {
7970 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7971 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007972 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007973 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7974 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7975 }
7976
7977 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7978 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007979 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007980 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7981 }
7982
7983 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7984 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7985 else
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007986 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007987 }
7988 }
7989 }
7990
7991 return 0;
7992}
7993
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00007994Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
7995 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7996 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7997 return Result;
7998
7999 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8000
8001 // If this is a cast of a cast
8002 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
8003 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8004 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8005 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8006 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
8007 // Get the sizes of the types involved
8008 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
8009 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8010 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8011 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8012 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
8013 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
8014 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
8015 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
8016 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
8017 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008018 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008019 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
8020 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
8021 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
8022 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008023 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008024 }
8025 return And;
8026 }
8027 }
8028 }
8029
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008030 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8031 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008032
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008033 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8034 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8035 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8036 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8037 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8038 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8039 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8040 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8041 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
8042 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
8043 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008044 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008045 }
Evan Chenge3779cf2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008046 }
8047
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008048 return 0;
8049}
8050
8051Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
8052 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8053 return I;
8054
8055 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8056
Dan Gohman35b76162008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008057 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
8058 if (Src->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
8059 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
8060 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8061 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf0f12022008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008062
8063 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8064 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
8065 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
8066 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
8067 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
8068 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
8069 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
8070 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8071
8072 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8073 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8074 // bits, it is already ready.
8075 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8076 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8077 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8078 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8079 // bits, just sext from i32.
8080 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8081 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8082 } else {
8083 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8084 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8085 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8086 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8087 }
8088 }
Chris Lattner8a2d0592008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008089
8090 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8091 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8092 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8093 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8094 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8095 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8096 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8097 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8098 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8099 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8100 // into:
8101 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8102 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8103 Value *A = 0;
8104 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8105 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
8106 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
8107 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8108 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8109 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8110 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8111 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8112 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
8113 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
8114 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8115 CI.getName()), CI);
8116 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8117 }
8118 }
8119
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008120 return 0;
8121}
8122
Chris Lattnerdf7e8402008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008123/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8124/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner5e0610f2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008125static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen6e547b42008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008126 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerdf7e8402008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008127 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen6e547b42008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008128 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8129 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner5e0610f2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008130 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerdf7e8402008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008131 return 0;
8132}
8133
8134/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8135/// through it until we get the source value.
8136static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
8137 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8138 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
8139 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
8140
8141 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8142 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8143 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8144 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8145 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8146 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8147 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner5e0610f2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008148 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerdf7e8402008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008149 return V;
8150 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8151 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner5e0610f2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008152 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerdf7e8402008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008153 return V;
8154 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8155 }
8156
8157 return V;
8158}
8159
8160Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8161 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8162 return I;
8163
8164 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
8165 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
8166 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
8167 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8168 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8169 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8170 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8171 default: break;
8172 case Instruction::Add:
8173 case Instruction::Sub:
8174 case Instruction::Mul:
8175 case Instruction::FDiv:
8176 case Instruction::FRem:
8177 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
8178 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
8179 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
8180 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8181 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
8182 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8183 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8184 // the cast, do this xform.
8185 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8186 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
8187 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8188 CI.getType(), CI);
8189 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8190 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008191 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerdf7e8402008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008192 }
8193 }
8194 break;
8195 }
8196 }
8197 return 0;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008198}
8199
8200Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8201 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8202}
8203
Chris Lattnerdeef1a72008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008204Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5f4d6912008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008205 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8206 if (OpI == 0)
8207 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8208
8209 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8210 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8211 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8212 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8213 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8214 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8215 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8216 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8217 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
8218 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8219 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdeef1a72008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008220
8221 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008222}
8223
Chris Lattnerdeef1a72008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008224Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5f4d6912008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008225 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8226 if (OpI == 0)
8227 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8228
8229 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8230 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8231 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8232 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8233 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8234 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8235 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8236 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8237 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
8238 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8239 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdeef1a72008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008240
8241 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008242}
8243
8244Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8245 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8246}
8247
8248Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8249 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8250}
8251
8252Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
8253 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
8254}
8255
Chris Lattner7c1626482008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008256Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8257 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8258 return I;
8259
8260 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8261 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8262
8263 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8264 ConstantInt *Cst;
8265 Value *X;
8266 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8267 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8268 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8269 // is a single-index GEP.
8270 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8271 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendling9594af02008-03-14 05:12:19 +00008272 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattner7c1626482008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008273
8274 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8275 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8276 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8277
8278 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8279 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8280 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008281 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattner7c1626482008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008282 }
8283 }
8284 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8285 // struct etc.
8286 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8287 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8288 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8289 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8290
8291 // Get the size of the pointee type.
8292 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
8293
8294 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8295 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8296 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8297
8298 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8299 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8300 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8301
8302 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8303 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008304 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattner7c1626482008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008305 }
8306 }
8307 return 0;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008308}
8309
8310Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
8311 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8312 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8313 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8314 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8315 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8316
8317 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
8318 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8319 return Result;
8320 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8321 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8322 return I;
8323 } else {
8324 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8325 return Result;
8326 }
8327
8328
8329 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8330 // be replaced by the operand.
8331 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8332 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8333
8334 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
8335 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8336 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8337 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8338
Nate Begemandf5b3612008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008339 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8340 // required for changing types.
8341 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8342 return 0;
8343
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008344 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8345 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8346 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8347 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8348 return V;
8349
8350 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8351 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
8352 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8353 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8354 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8355 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8356 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8357 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8358 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8359 ++NumZeros;
8360 }
8361
8362 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8363 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8364 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008365 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8366 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008367 }
8368 }
8369
8370 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8371 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8372 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8373 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
8374 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +00008375 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
8376 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
8377 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
8378 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008379 CastInst *Tmp;
8380 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8381 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8382 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8383 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8384 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8385 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8386 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
8387 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8388 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8389 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8390 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
8391 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8392 // know the vector types match #elts.
8393 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
8394 }
8395 }
8396 }
8397 }
8398 return 0;
8399}
8400
8401/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8402/// %C = or %A, %B
8403/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8404/// into:
8405/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8406/// %D = or %A, %C
8407///
8408/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8409/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8410/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8411///
8412static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8413 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8414 case Instruction::Add:
8415 case Instruction::Mul:
8416 case Instruction::And:
8417 case Instruction::Or:
8418 case Instruction::Xor:
8419 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8420 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8421 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
8422 case Instruction::LShr:
8423 case Instruction::AShr:
8424 return 1;
8425 default:
8426 return 0; // Cannot fold
8427 }
8428}
8429
8430/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8431/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8432static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8433 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8434 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8435 case Instruction::Add:
8436 case Instruction::Sub:
8437 case Instruction::Or:
8438 case Instruction::Xor:
8439 case Instruction::Shl:
8440 case Instruction::LShr:
8441 case Instruction::AShr:
8442 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
8443 case Instruction::And:
8444 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
8445 case Instruction::Mul:
8446 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8447 }
8448}
8449
8450/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8451/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8452Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8453 Instruction *FI) {
8454 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8455 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8456 // merge.
8457 if (TI->isCast()) {
8458 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8459 return 0;
8460 } else {
8461 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8462 }
8463
8464 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008465 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8466 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008467 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008468 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008469 TI->getType());
8470 }
8471
8472 // Only handle binary operators here.
8473 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
8474 return 0;
8475
8476 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8477 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8478 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8479 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8480 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8481 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8482 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8483 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8484 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8485 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8486 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8487 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8488 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8489 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8490 return 0;
8491 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8492 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8493 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8494 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8495 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8496 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8497 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8498 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8499 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8500 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8501 } else {
8502 return 0;
8503 }
8504
8505 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008506 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8507 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008508 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8509
8510 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8511 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008512 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008513 else
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008514 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008515 }
8516 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8517 return 0;
8518}
8519
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008520/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8521/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8522///
8523Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8524 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8525 bool Changed = false;
8526 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8527 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8528 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8529 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8530 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8531
8532 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8533 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8534 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8535 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman35b76162008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008536 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008537 switch (Pred) {
8538 default: break;
8539 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8540 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8541 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8542 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8543 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8544 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8545 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8546 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8547 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8548 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8549 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8550 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8551 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8552 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8553 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8554 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8555 Changed = true;
8556 }
8557 break;
8558 }
8559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8561 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8562 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8564 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8565 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8566 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8567 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8568 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8569 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8570 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8571 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8572 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8573 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8574 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8575 Changed = true;
8576 }
8577 break;
8578 }
8579 }
8580
Dan Gohman35b76162008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008581 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
8582 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
8583 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8584 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(0)) &&
8585 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)))
8586 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
8587 else if (!match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)) ||
8588 !match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(0)))
8589 Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
8590 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
8591 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8592 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8593 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8594 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
8595
8596 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
8597 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
8598 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8599 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8600 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8601 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
8602 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
8603 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
8604 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8605 *ICI);
Dan Gohman47a60772008-11-02 00:17:33 +00008606 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
8607 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman35b76162008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008608 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
8609
8610 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
8611 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
8612 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
8613
8614 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
8615 }
8616 }
8617 }
8618
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008619 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8620 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8621 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8623 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8624 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8625 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8626 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8627
8628 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8629 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8630 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8632 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8633 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8634 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8635 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8636 }
8637
8638 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8639
8640 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8641}
8642
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008643Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
8644 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8645 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8646 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8647
8648 // select true, X, Y -> X
8649 // select false, X, Y -> Y
8650 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
8651 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
8652
8653 // select C, X, X -> X
8654 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8655 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8656
8657 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8659 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8660 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8661 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8662 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8663 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8664 else
8665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8666 }
8667
8668 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
8669 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
8670 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
8671 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008672 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008673 } else {
8674 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8675 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008676 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008677 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008678 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008679 }
8680 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
8681 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
8682 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008683 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008684 } else {
8685 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8686 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008687 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008688 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008689 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008690 }
8691 }
Chris Lattner53f85a72007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008692
8693 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8694 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8695 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008696 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner53f85a72007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008697 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008698 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008699 }
8700
8701 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8702 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8703 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
8704 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
8705 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008706 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008707 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
8708 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
8709 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008710 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008711 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008712 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008713 }
8714
8715 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
8716
8717 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
8718
8719 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
8720 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
8721 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
8722 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
8723 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
8724 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
8725 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
8726 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8727 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008728 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008729 ShAmt, "ones");
8730 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8731
8732 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8733 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8734 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
8735 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8736 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8737 if (SRASize < SISize)
8738 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8739 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8740 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008741 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008742 }
8743 }
8744
8745
8746 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
8747 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
8748 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8749 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
8750 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
8751 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
8752 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8753 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8754 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
8755 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8756 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8757 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
8758 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8759 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
8760 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8761 // true or false val is the zero.
8762 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
8763 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8764 Value *V = ICA;
8765 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008766 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008767 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8769 }
8770 }
8771 }
8772
8773 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
8774 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8775 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
8776 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen2e1b7692007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008777 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8778 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8779 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8780 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8781 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8782 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8783 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8784 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8785 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen2e1b7692007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008787 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008788 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8789 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008791 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008792
8793 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
8794 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen2e1b7692007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008795 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8796 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8797 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8798 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8799 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8800 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8801 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8802 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8803 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8804 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8805 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008806 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8807 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8808 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008809 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008810 }
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008811 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008812 }
8813
8814 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman58c09632008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008815 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8816 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8817 return Result;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008818
8819 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8820 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8821 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
8822 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8823
8824 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8825 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8826 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8827 return IV;
8828
8829 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8830 // even legal for FP.
8831 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8832 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8833 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8834 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8835 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8836 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8837 }
8838
8839 if (AddOp) {
8840 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8841 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8842 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8843 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8844 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8845 }
8846
8847 if (OtherAddOp) {
8848 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8849 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8850 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8851 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8852 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8853 } else {
8854 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008855 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008856 }
8857
8858 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8859 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8860 if (AddOp != TI)
8861 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8862 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb91ea9d2008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008863 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8864 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008865
8866 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008867 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008868 }
8869 }
8870 }
8871
8872 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
8873 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
8874 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8875 // transformation we are doing here.
8876 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8877 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8878 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8879 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8880 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8881 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8882 OpToFold = 1;
8883 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8884 OpToFold = 2;
8885 }
8886
8887 if (OpToFold) {
8888 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
8889 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb91ea9d2008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008890 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8891 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008892 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
8893 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
8894 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008895 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008896 else {
8897 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8898 }
8899 }
8900 }
8901
8902 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8903 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8904 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8905 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8906 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8907 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8908 OpToFold = 1;
8909 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8910 OpToFold = 2;
8911 }
8912
8913 if (OpToFold) {
8914 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
8915 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb91ea9d2008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008916 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8917 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008918 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
8919 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
8920 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008921 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008922 else
8923 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8924 }
8925 }
8926 }
8927
8928 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8929 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8930 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8931 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8932 return &SI;
8933 }
8934
8935 return 0;
8936}
8937
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008938/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8939/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8940/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8941/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8942/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8943///
8944static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8945 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattner47cf3452007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008946
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008947 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8948 if (!U) return Align;
8949
8950 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8951 default: break;
8952 case Instruction::BitCast:
8953 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8954 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008955 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8956 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greife92fbe22008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008957 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008958 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8959 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008960 AllZeroOperands = false;
8961 break;
8962 }
Chris Lattner47cf3452007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008963
8964 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8965 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008966 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattner47cf3452007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008967 }
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008968 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00008969 }
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008970 }
8971
8972 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8973 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8974 // of the global.
8975 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8976 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8977 Align = PrefAlign;
8978 }
8979 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8980 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8981 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8982 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8983 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8984 Align = PrefAlign;
8985 }
8986 }
8987
8988 return Align;
8989}
8990
8991/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8992/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8993/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8994/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8995unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8996 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8997 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8998 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8999 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9000 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9001 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9002 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9003 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9004
9005 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9006 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9007
9008 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9009 return Align;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009010}
9011
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009012Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009013 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
9014 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009015 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
9016 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9017
9018 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
9019 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
9020 return MI;
9021 }
9022
9023 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9024 // load/store.
9025 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9026 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9027
Chris Lattnerc669fb62008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009028 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9029 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9030 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9031 // case.
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009032 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner5af8a912008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009033 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9034
9035 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattnerc669fb62008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009036 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009037
Chris Lattnerc669fb62008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009038 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009039 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattnerc669fb62008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009040
9041 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9042 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9043 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9044 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9045 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9046 // integer datatype.
9047 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9048 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
9049 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
9050 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9051 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohmanb8e94f62008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009052 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattnerc669fb62008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009053 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9054 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9055 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9056 else
9057 break;
9058 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9059 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9060 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9061 else
9062 break;
9063 } else
9064 break;
9065 }
9066
Dan Gohmanb8e94f62008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009067 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattnerc669fb62008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009068 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
9069 }
9070 }
9071
9072
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009073 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9074 // infer, use it.
9075 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9076 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9077
9078 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
9079 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattnerc669fb62008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009080 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9081 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9082 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9083
9084 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9085 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
9086 return MI;
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009087}
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009088
Chris Lattner5af8a912008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009089Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9090 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
9091 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
9092 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
9093 return MI;
9094 }
9095
9096 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9097 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9098 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
9099 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
9100 return 0;
9101 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
9102 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9103
9104 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9105 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9106
9107 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9108 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
9109 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
9110
9111 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
9112 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
9113
9114 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9115 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9116
9117 // Extract the fill value and store.
9118 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
9119 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
9120 Alignment), *MI);
9121
9122 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9123 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
9124 return MI;
9125 }
9126
9127 return 0;
9128}
9129
9130
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009131/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9132/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9133/// the heavy lifting.
9134///
9135Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
9136 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9137 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9138
9139 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9140 // visitCallSite.
9141 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
9142 bool Changed = false;
9143
9144 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9145 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9146 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9147
9148 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
9149 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
9150 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9151 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9152 // alignment is sufficient.
9153 }
9154 }
9155
9156 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9157 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9158 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009159 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009160 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9161 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9162 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner13c2d6e2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009163 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
9164 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
9165 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009166 else
Chris Lattner13c2d6e2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009167 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
9168 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009169 Changed = true;
9170 }
Chris Lattner59b27d92008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009171
9172 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9173 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9174 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009175 }
9176
9177 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9178 // set, update the alignment.
9179 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner00ae5132008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009180 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9181 return I;
Chris Lattner5af8a912008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009182 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9183 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9184 return I;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009185 }
9186
9187 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009188 }
9189
9190 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9191 default: break;
9192 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9193 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9194 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9195 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9196 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9197 break;
9198 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9199 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9200 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9201 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9202 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9203 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9204 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9205 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9206 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
9207 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
9208 CI);
9209 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009210 }
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009211 break;
9212 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9213 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9214 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9215 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9216 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9217 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
9218 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9219 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9220 }
9221 break;
9222 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9223 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9224 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009225 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9226 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9227 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9228 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
9229 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9230 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9231 }
9232 break;
9233
9234 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9235 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9236 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
9237 uint64_t UndefElts;
9238 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
9239 UndefElts)) {
9240 II->setOperand(1, V);
9241 return II;
9242 }
9243 break;
9244 }
9245
9246 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9247 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9248 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9249 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009250
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009251 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9252 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9253 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9254 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9255 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9256 AllEltsOk = false;
9257 break;
9258 }
9259 }
9260
9261 if (AllEltsOk) {
9262 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9263 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9264 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
9265 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009266
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009267 // Only extract each element once.
9268 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9269 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9270
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009271 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009272 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9273 continue;
9274 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9275 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9276
9277 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9278 Instruction *Elt =
9279 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
9280 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9281 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009282 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009283
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009284 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9285 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9286 i, "tmp");
9287 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009288 }
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009289 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009290 }
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009291 }
9292 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009293
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009294 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9295 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9296 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9297 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9298 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9299 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9300 if (&*++BI == II)
9301 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009302 }
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009303 }
9304
9305 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9306 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9307 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9308 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9309 bool CannotRemove = false;
9310 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9311 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9312 CannotRemove = true;
9313 break;
9314 }
Chris Lattnera6b477c2008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009315 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9316 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9317 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9318 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9319 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9320 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9321 } else {
9322 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9323 // restore.
Chris Lattner416d91c2008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009324 CannotRemove = true;
9325 break;
9326 }
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009327 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009328 }
Chris Lattner989ba312008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009329
9330 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9331 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9332 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9333 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9334 break;
9335 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009336 }
9337
9338 return visitCallSite(II);
9339}
9340
9341// InvokeInst simplification
9342//
9343Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
9344 return visitCallSite(&II);
9345}
9346
Dale Johannesen96021832008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009347/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9348/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen35615462008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009349static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9350 const CastInst * const CI,
9351 const TargetData * const TD,
9352 const int ix) {
9353 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9354 return false;
9355
9356 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9357 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9358 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009359 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen35615462008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009360 return true;
9361
9362 const Type* SrcTy =
9363 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9364 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9365 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9366 return false;
9367 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
9368 return false;
9369 return true;
9370}
9371
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009372// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9373//
9374Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
9375 bool Changed = false;
9376
9377 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9378 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9379 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9380
9381 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9382
9383 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9384 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9385 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9386 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9387 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
9388 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lambbb2f2222007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009389 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9390 OldCall);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009391 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9392 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9393 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9394 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9395 return 0;
9396 }
9397
9398 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9399 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9400 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9401 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
9402 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lambbb2f2222007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009403 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009404 CS.getInstruction());
9405
9406 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9407 CS.getInstruction()->
9408 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9409
9410 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9411 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009412 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9413 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009414 }
9415 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9416 }
9417
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009418 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9419 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9420 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9421 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9422
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009423 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9424 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9425 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen502336c2008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009426 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009427 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9428 // the call.
9429 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen35615462008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009430 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9431 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9432 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9433 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9434 Changed = true;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009435 }
Dale Johannesen35615462008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009436 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009437 }
9438
Duncan Sands2937e352007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009439 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sands7868f3c2007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009440 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sands2937e352007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009441 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sands7868f3c2007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009442 Changed = true;
9443 }
9444
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009445 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
9446}
9447
9448// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9449// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9450//
9451bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9452 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9453 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
9454 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9455 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
9456 return false;
9457 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
9458 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009459 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009460
9461 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9462 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9463 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9464 //
9465 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9466 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sands7901ce12008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009467 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009468
Duncan Sands7901ce12008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009469 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Pateld091d322008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009470 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9471
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009472 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sands7901ce12008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009473 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlingd9644a42008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009474 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sands7901ce12008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009475 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9476 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9477 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands886cadb2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009478 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009479 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9480
Duncan Sands5c489582008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009481 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sands5c489582008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009482 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sands7901ce12008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009483 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sands5c489582008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009484 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9485
Chris Lattner1c8733e2008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009486 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009487 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009488 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sandsdbe97dc2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009489 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9490 }
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009491
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009492 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9493 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9494 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9495 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9496 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9497 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9498 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9499 UI != E; ++UI)
9500 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9501 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
9502 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
9503 return false;
9504 }
9505
9506 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9507 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
9508
9509 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9510 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9511 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9512 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sands5c489582008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009513
9514 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009515 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9516
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009517 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9518 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner1c8733e2008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009519 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sands5c489582008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009520
Duncan Sands7901ce12008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009521 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9522 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009523 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sands7901ce12008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009524 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9525 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009526 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009527 }
9528
9529 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
9530 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner1c8733e2008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009531 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009532
Chris Lattner1c8733e2008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009533 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9534 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009535 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sands4ced1f82008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009536 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9537 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner1c8733e2008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009538 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9539 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sands4ced1f82008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009540 break;
Devang Patele480dfa2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009541 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009542 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sands4ced1f82008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009543 return false;
9544 }
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009545
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009546 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9547 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9548 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9549 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009550 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009551 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9552
9553 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009554 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009555
9556 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9557 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009558 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009559
9560 // Add the new return attributes.
9561 if (RAttrs)
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009562 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009563
9564 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9565 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9566 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9567 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9568 Args.push_back(*AI);
9569 } else {
9570 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
9571 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009572 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009573 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
9574 }
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009575
9576 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009577 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009578 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009579 }
9580
9581 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9582 // now...
9583 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9584 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9585
9586 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009587 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009588 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
9589 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9590 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
9591 } else {
9592 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9593 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9594 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9595 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9596 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
9597 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9598 PTy, false);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009599 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009600 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9601 Args.push_back(Cast);
9602 } else {
9603 Args.push_back(*AI);
9604 }
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009605
Duncan Sands4ced1f82008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009606 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009607 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009608 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sands4ced1f82008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009609 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009610 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009611 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009612
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009613 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9614 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9615
Duncan Sands7901ce12008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009616 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009617 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
9618
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009619 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsc849e662008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009620
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009621 Instruction *NC;
9622 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009623 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb91ea9d2008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009624 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9625 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencer6b0b09a2007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009626 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009627 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009628 } else {
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009629 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9630 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsf5588dc2007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009631 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9632 if (CI->isTailCall())
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009633 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsf5588dc2007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009634 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009635 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009636 }
9637
9638 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
9639 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sands5c489582008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009640 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009641 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009642 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sands5c489582008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009643 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009644 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009645
9646 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9647 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9648 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman514277c2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009649 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009650 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9651 } else {
9652 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9653 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9654 }
9655 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
9656 } else {
9657 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
9658 }
9659 }
9660
9661 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9662 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
9663 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9664 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9665 return true;
9666}
9667
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009668// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9669// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9670//
9671Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9672 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9673 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9674 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009675 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009676
9677 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9678 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009679 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009680 return 0;
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009681
9682 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9683 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9684
Anton Korobeynikov48fc88f2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009685 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009686 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9687 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9688
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009689 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner1c8733e2008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009690 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009691 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9692 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009693 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009694
9695 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9696 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9697 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009698 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009699 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9700 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009701 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009702 break;
9703 }
9704
9705 if (NestTy) {
9706 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9707 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9708 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9709
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009710 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner1c8733e2008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009711 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009712
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009713 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009714 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9715
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009716 // Add any result attributes.
9717 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009718 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009719
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009720 {
9721 unsigned Idx = 1;
9722 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9723 do {
9724 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009725 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009726 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9727 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9728 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9729 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009730 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009731 }
9732
9733 if (I == E)
9734 break;
9735
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009736 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009737 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009738 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009739 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009740 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009741
9742 ++Idx, ++I;
9743 } while (1);
9744 }
9745
Devang Patelf2a4a922008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009746 // Add any function attributes.
9747 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9748 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9749
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009750 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9751 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009752 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009753
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009754 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009755 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9756
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009757 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009758 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009759 {
9760 unsigned Idx = 1;
9761 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9762 E = FTy->param_end();
9763
9764 do {
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009765 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9766 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009767 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009768
9769 if (I == E)
9770 break;
9771
Duncan Sands48b81112008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009772 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009773 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009774
9775 ++Idx, ++I;
9776 } while (1);
9777 }
9778
9779 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9780 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9781 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsf5588dc2007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009782 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lambbb2f2222007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009783 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9784 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009785 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009786
9787 Instruction *NewCaller;
9788 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009789 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9790 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9791 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9792 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009793 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009794 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009795 } else {
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009796 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9797 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009798 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9799 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9800 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9801 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Pateld222f862008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009802 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sands74833f22007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009803 }
9804 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9805 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9806 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9807 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9808 return 0;
9809 }
9810 }
9811
9812 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9813 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9814 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9815 Constant *NewCallee =
9816 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9817 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9818 return CS.getInstruction();
9819}
9820
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009821/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9822/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9823/// and a single binop.
9824Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9825 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9826 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9827 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
9828 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
9829 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9830 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9831
9832 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9833 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
9834
9835 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9836 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
9837 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
9838 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
9839 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
9840 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
9841 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9842 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9843 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
9844 return 0;
9845
9846 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9847 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9848 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9849 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9850 return 0;
9851
9852 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9853 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9854 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
9855 }
9856
9857 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9858
9859 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9860 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9861 // hide them behind a phi.
9862 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9863 return 0;
9864
9865 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9866 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9867 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
9868 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb91ea9d2008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009869 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9870 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009871 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9872 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
9873 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9874 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9875 }
9876
9877 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb91ea9d2008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009878 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9879 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009880 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9881 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
9882 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9883 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9884 }
9885
9886 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9887 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9888 if (NewLHS) {
9889 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9890 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9891 }
9892 if (NewRHS) {
9893 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9894 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9895 }
9896 }
9897
9898 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009899 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009900 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009901 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009902 RHSVal);
9903 else {
9904 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009905 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009906 }
9907}
9908
9909/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9910/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9911/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9912/// block it is in.
9913///
9914/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9915/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9916/// to a register.
9917static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9918 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9919
9920 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9921 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9922 return false;
9923
9924 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9925 // profitable to do this xform.
9926 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9927 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9928 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9929 UI != E; ++UI) {
9930 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9931 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9932 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9933 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9934 }
9935 isAddressTaken = true;
9936 break;
9937 }
9938
9939 if (!isAddressTaken)
9940 return false;
9941 }
9942
9943 return true;
9944}
9945
9946
9947// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9948// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9949// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9950Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9951 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9952
9953 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9954 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9955 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9956 // code size and simplifying code.
9957 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9958 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
9959 bool isVolatile = false;
9960 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9961 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
9962 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
9963 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9964 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
9965 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
9966 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9967 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9968 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9969 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9970 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9971 // load and the PHI.
9972 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9973 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9974 return 0;
Chris Lattner2d9fdd82008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009975
9976 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9977 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9978 // the path through the other successor.
9979 if (isVolatile &&
9980 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9981 return 0;
9982
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +00009983 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
9984 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
9985 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9986 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9987 return 0;
9988 } else {
9989 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9990 }
9991
9992 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9993 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9994 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9995 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
9996 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
9997 return 0;
9998 if (CastSrcTy) {
9999 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10000 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
10001 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
10002 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10003 // the load and the PHI.
10004 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10005 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
10006 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
10007 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf7867012008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010008
Chris Lattner2d9fdd82008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010009 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10010 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10011 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattnerf7867012008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010012 if (isVolatile &&
10013 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10014 return 0;
10015
10016
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010017 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10018 return 0;
10019 }
10020 }
10021
10022 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10023 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010024 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10025 PN.getName()+".in");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010026 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10027
10028 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10029 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
10030
10031 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
10032 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10033 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10034 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10035 InVal = 0;
10036 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10037 }
10038
10039 Value *PhiVal;
10040 if (InVal) {
10041 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10042 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10043 PhiVal = InVal;
10044 delete NewPN;
10045 } else {
10046 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10047 PhiVal = NewPN;
10048 }
10049
10050 // Insert and return the new operation.
10051 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010052 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattnerfc984e92008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010053 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010054 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerfc984e92008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010055 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010056 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010057 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerfc984e92008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010058 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10059
10060 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10061 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10062 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10063 if (isVolatile)
10064 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10065 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10066
10067 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010068}
10069
10070/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10071/// that is dead.
10072static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10073 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
10074 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10075 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10076
10077 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
10078 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
10079 return true;
Chris Lattneradf2e342007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010080
10081 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10082 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10083 return false;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010084
10085 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10086 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
10087
10088 return false;
10089}
10090
Chris Lattner27b695d2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010091/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10092/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10093/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10094static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10095 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10096 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10097 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10098 return true;
10099
10100 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10101 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10102 return false;
10103
10104 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10105 // the value.
10106 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10107 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10108 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10109 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10110 return false;
10111 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10112 return false;
10113 }
10114
10115 return true;
10116}
10117
10118
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010119// PHINode simplification
10120//
10121Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
10122 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
10123 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
10124
10125 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10126 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10127
10128 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10129 // reducing code size.
10130 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
10131 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10132 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10133 return Result;
10134
10135 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10136 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10137 // PHI)... break the cycle.
10138 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10139 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10140 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
10141 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
10142 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10143 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
10144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10145 }
10146
10147 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10148 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10149 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10150 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10151 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10152 // late.
10153 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10154 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10155 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
10156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10157 }
10158 }
10159
Chris Lattner27b695d2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010160 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10161 // same value, for example:
10162 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10163 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10164 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10165 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10166 {
10167 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10168 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10169 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10170 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10171 ++InValNo;
10172
10173 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10174 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10175
10176 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10177 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10178 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10179 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10180 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10181 break;
10182 }
10183
10184 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10185 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10186 // the value.
10187 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10188 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10189 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10190 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10191 }
10192 }
10193 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010194 return 0;
10195}
10196
10197static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10198 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10199 InstCombiner *IC) {
10200 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10201 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10202 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10203 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10204 // used for address computation.
10205 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10206 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10207 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10208 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
10209}
10210
10211
10212Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
10213 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
10214 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
10215 // If so, eliminate the noop.
10216 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
10217 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
10218
10219 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
10220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
10221
10222 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10223 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10224 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10225
10226 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
10227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
10228
10229 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
10230 bool MadeChange = false;
10231
10232 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010233 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
10234 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010235 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010236 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010237 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
10238 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
10239 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
10240 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
10241 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
10242 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10243 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010244 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010245 }
10246 }
10247 }
10248 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman5d639ed2008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010249 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
10250 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010251 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
10252 // obvious.
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010253 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010254 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010255 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010256 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010257 MadeChange = true;
10258 } else {
10259 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10260 GEP);
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010261 *i = Op;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010262 MadeChange = true;
10263 }
Dan Gohman5d639ed2008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010264 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10265 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10266 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
10267 MadeChange = true;
10268 } else {
10269 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10270 GEP);
10271 *i = Op;
10272 MadeChange = true;
10273 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010274 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010275 }
10276 }
10277 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
10278
10279 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
10280 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
10281 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattnerc59171a2007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010282 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10283 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
10284 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10285 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10286 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10287 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattner551a5872007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010288 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10289 if (I != BCI) {
10290 I->takeName(BCI);
10291 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10292 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10293 }
Chris Lattnerc59171a2007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010294 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner551a5872007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010295 }
Chris Lattnerc59171a2007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010296 }
10297 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
10298 }
10299 }
10300
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010301 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10302 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10303 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10304 //
10305 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
10306 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
10307 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
10308
10309 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
10310 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10311 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10312 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10313 //
10314 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10315 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10316 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10317
10318 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
10319
10320 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10321 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10322 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10323 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
10324 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
10325
10326 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
10327 if (EndsWithSequential) {
10328 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10329 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10330 //
10331 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
10332 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10333 Sum = GO1;
10334 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10335 Sum = SO1;
10336 } else {
10337 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10338 // target's pointer size.
10339 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10340 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
10341 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
10342 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
10343 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
10344 } else {
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010345 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10346 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010347 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
10348 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
10349
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010350 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010351 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
10352 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
10353 } else {
10354 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
10355 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10356 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10357 }
10358 }
10359 }
10360 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10361 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10362 else {
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010363 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010364 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
10365 }
10366 }
10367
10368 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10369 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10370 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10371 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10372 return &GEP;
10373 } else {
10374 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10375 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10376 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10377 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10378 }
10379 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
10380 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
10381 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
10382 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
10383 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10384 SrcGEPOperands.end());
10385 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10386 }
10387
10388 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010389 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10390 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010391
10392 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
10393 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10394 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10395
10396 // Scan for nonconstants...
10397 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
10398 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10399 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10400 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10401
10402 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
10403 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10404 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
10405
10406 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10407 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10408 }
10409 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
10410 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10411 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10412 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewicz5b5ab532007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010413 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10414 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010415 //
10416 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10417 //
10418 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10419 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10420 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10421 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10422 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10423 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10424 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10425 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10426 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10427 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10428 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10429 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10430 return &GEP;
10431 }
10432 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10433 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewicz5b5ab532007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010434 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10435 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010436 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10437 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10438 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010439 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10440 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greene393be882007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010441 Value *Idx[2];
10442 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10443 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010444 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010445 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010446 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10447 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
10448 }
10449
10450 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewicz5b5ab532007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010451 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010452 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewicz5b5ab532007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010453 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010454
Wojciech Matyjewicz5b5ab532007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010455 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010456 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010457 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010458
10459 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10460 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10461 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10462 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10463 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10464 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10465 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10466 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
10467 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
10468 Scale = CI;
10469 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10470 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10471 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10472 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10473 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10474 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
10475 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10476 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10477 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10478 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10479 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10480 }
10481 }
Wojciech Matyjewicz5b5ab532007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010482
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010483 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewicz5b5ab532007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010484 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10485 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10486 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10487 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10488 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10489 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10490 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010491 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
10492 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewicz5b5ab532007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010493 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010494 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010495 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10496 }
10497
10498 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greene393be882007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010499 Value *Idx[2];
10500 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10501 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010502 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010503 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010504 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10505 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10506 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
10507 }
10508 }
10509 }
10510 }
10511
10512 return 0;
10513}
10514
10515Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10516 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010517 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010518 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10519 const Type *NewTy =
10520 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
10521 AllocationInst *New = 0;
10522
10523 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10524 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
10525 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
10526 else {
10527 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
10528 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
10529 }
10530
10531 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
10532
10533 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10534 // allocas if possible...
10535 //
10536 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10537 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10538
10539 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10540 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10541 //
10542 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greene393be882007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010543 Value *Idx[2];
10544 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10545 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010546 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10547 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010548
10549 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10550 // allocation.
10551 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
10552 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10553 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10554 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010555 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010556
10557 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10558 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10559 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
10560 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sandsf99fdc62007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010561 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10563
10564 return 0;
10565}
10566
10567Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10568 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10569
10570 // free undef -> unreachable.
10571 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10572 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
10573 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lambbb2f2222007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010574 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010575 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10576 }
10577
10578 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10579 // when lots of inlining happens.
10580 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
10581 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10582
10583 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10584 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10585 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10586 return &FI;
10587 }
10588
10589 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10590 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10591 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10592 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10593 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10594 return &FI;
10595 }
10596 }
10597
10598 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10599 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10600 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10601 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10602 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10603 }
10604
10605 return 0;
10606}
10607
10608
10609/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patela0f8ea82007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010610static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling44a36ea2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010611 const TargetData *TD) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010612 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
10613 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10614
Devang Patela0f8ea82007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010615 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10616 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10617 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng833501d2008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010618 std::string Str;
10619 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patela0f8ea82007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010620 unsigned len = Str.length();
10621 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10622 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10623 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10624 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling44a36ea2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010625 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10626 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10627 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10628 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10629 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10630 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10631 }
10632 } else {
10633 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10634 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10635 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10636 }
10637 // Append NULL at the end.
10638 SingleChar = 0;
10639 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10640 }
10641 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10642 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patela0f8ea82007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010643 }
10644 }
10645 }
10646
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010647 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10648 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10649 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10650
10651 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
10652 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
10653 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10654 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10655 // constants.
10656 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10657 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10658 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
10659 Value *Idxs[2];
10660 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10661 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
10662 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10663 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10664 }
10665
10666 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
10667 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10668 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10669 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10670 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
10671 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10672 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
10673
10674 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10675 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10676 // the result of the loaded value.
10677 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10678 CI->getName(),
10679 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10680 // Now cast the result of the load.
10681 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
10682 }
10683 }
10684 }
10685 return 0;
10686}
10687
10688/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
10689/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10690/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10691/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10692static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands9b27dbe2007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010693 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10694 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10695
Duncan Sandse40a94a2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010696 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands9b27dbe2007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010697 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sandse40a94a2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010698 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands9b27dbe2007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010699 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010700
10701 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10702 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
10703 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10704 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10705 // the load entirely).
10706 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10707
10708 while (BBI != E) {
10709 --BBI;
10710
Chris Lattner476983a2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010711 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10712 // marked invalid.
10713 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10714 return false;
10715
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010716 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10717 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner476983a2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010718 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010719 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner476983a2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010720 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010721
10722 }
10723 return false;
10724}
10725
Dan Gohman0ff5a1f2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010726/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
10727/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
10728/// value in code like this:
10729/// %t0 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10730/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
10731/// %t1 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10732/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
10733///
10734static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
10735 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
10736 if (A == B) return true;
10737
10738 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
10739 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
10740 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
10741 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
10742 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
10743 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
10744 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
10745 return true;
10746
10747 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
10748 return false;
10749}
10750
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010751Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10752 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
10753
Dan Gohman5c4d0e12007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010754 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010755 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10756 if (KnownAlign >
10757 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10758 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman5c4d0e12007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010759 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10760
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010761 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
10762 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patela0f8ea82007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010763 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010764 return Res;
10765
10766 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10767 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
10768
Dan Gohman0ff5a1f2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010769 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
10770 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
10771 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
10772 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
10773 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != LI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10774 --ScanInsts) {
10775 --BBI;
10776
10777 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10778 if (equivalentAddressValues(SI->getOperand(1), LI.getOperand(0)))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010779 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Dan Gohman0ff5a1f2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010780 } else if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10781 if (equivalentAddressValues(LIB->getOperand(0), LI.getOperand(0)))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010782 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Dan Gohman0ff5a1f2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010783 }
10784
10785 // Don't skip over things that can modify memory.
10786 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10787 break;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010788 }
10789
Christopher Lamb2c175392007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010790 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10791 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10792 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10793 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10794 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010795 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10796 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10797 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10798 // CFG.
10799 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10800 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10801 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10802 }
Christopher Lamb2c175392007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010803 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010804
10805 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10806 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lamb2c175392007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010807 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10808 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10809 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010810 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10811 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10812 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
10813 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10814 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10816 }
10817
10818 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10819 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
10820 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
10821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
10822
10823 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010824 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010825 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10826 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
10827 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
10828 if (Constant *V =
10829 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
10830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
10831 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10832 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10833 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10834 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10835 // CFG.
10836 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10837 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10839 }
10840
10841 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patela0f8ea82007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010842 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010843 return Res;
10844 }
Anton Korobeynikov8522e1c2008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010845 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010846 }
Chris Lattner0270a112007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010847
10848 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10849 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands52fb8732008-10-01 15:25:41 +000010850 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner0270a112007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010851 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10852 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10853 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10854 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10855 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10856 }
10857 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010858
10859 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
10860 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10861 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10862 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10863 //
10864 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10865 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10866 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10867 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10868 // unconditionally.
10869 //
10870 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10871 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
10872 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10873 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
10874 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
10875 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
10876 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
10877 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010878 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010879 }
10880
10881 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10882 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10883 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10884 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10885 return &LI;
10886 }
10887
10888 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10889 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10890 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10891 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10892 return &LI;
10893 }
10894 }
10895 }
10896 return 0;
10897}
10898
10899/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
10900/// when possible.
10901static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10902 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10903 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10904
10905 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10906 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10907 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10908
10909 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
10910 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10911 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10912 // constants.
10913 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10914 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10915 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
10916 Value* Idxs[2];
10917 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10918 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
10919 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10920 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10921 }
10922
10923 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10924 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10925 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
10926
10927 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10928 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10929 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
10930 Value *NewCast;
10931 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
10932 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10933 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10934 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10935 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10936 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
10937 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
10938 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10939 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
10940 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10941 }
10942 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
10943 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
10944 else
10945 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010946 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010947 SI);
10948 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10949 }
10950 }
10951 }
10952 return 0;
10953}
10954
10955Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10956 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10957 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10958
10959 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
10960 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10961 ++NumCombined;
10962 return 0;
10963 }
10964
10965 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10966 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnera02bacc2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010967 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010968 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10969 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10970 ++NumCombined;
10971 return 0;
10972 }
10973
10974 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10975 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10976 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10977 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10978 ++NumCombined;
10979 return 0;
10980 }
10981 }
10982
Dan Gohman5c4d0e12007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010983 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohman2d648bb2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010984 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10985 if (KnownAlign >
10986 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10987 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman5c4d0e12007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010988 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10989
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000010990 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10991 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10992 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10993 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10994 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10995 --ScanInsts) {
10996 --BBI;
10997
10998 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10999 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Dan Gohman0ff5a1f2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011000 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11001 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011002 ++NumDeadStore;
11003 ++BBI;
11004 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11005 continue;
11006 }
11007 break;
11008 }
11009
11010 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11011 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11012 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11013 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman0ff5a1f2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011014 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11015 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011016 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11017 ++NumCombined;
11018 return 0;
11019 }
11020 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11021 // may not be dead.
11022 break;
11023 }
11024
11025 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner84504282008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011026 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011027 break;
11028 }
11029
11030
11031 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
11032
11033 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
11034 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
11035 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
11036 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
11037 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
11038 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
11039 ++NumCombined;
11040 }
11041 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11042 }
11043
11044 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11045 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
11046 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11047 ++NumCombined;
11048 return 0;
11049 }
11050
11051 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11052 // source instead.
11053 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
11054 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11055 return Res;
11056 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
11057 if (CE->isCast())
11058 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11059 return Res;
11060
11061
11062 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
11063 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
11064 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
11065 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
11066 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11067 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11068 return 0; // xform done!
11069
11070 return 0;
11071}
11072
11073/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11074/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11075/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11076///
11077/// Simplify things like:
11078/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11079/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11080///
11081bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11082 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11083
11084 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11085 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11086 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
11087 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
11088
11089 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11090 // the other predecessor.
11091 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11092 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
11093 if (*PI != StoreBB)
11094 OtherBB = *PI;
11095 ++PI;
11096 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
11097 return false;
11098
11099 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
11100 if (OtherBB)
11101 return false;
11102 OtherBB = *PI;
11103 }
11104 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
11105 return false;
Eli Friedmanab39f9a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011106
11107 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11108 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11109 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11110 return false;
11111
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011112 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11113 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
11114 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
11115 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11116 return false;
11117
11118 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11119 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11120 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11121 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
11122 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
11123 --BBI;
11124 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11125 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11126 return false;
11127 } else {
11128 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
11129 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11130 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11131 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11132 return false;
11133
11134 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
11135 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11136 // lives in OtherBB.
11137 for (;; --BBI) {
11138 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11139 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11140 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11141 return false;
11142 break;
11143 }
Eli Friedman3a311d52008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011144 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11145 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11146 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011147 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11148 return false;
11149 }
11150
11151 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman3a311d52008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011152 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11153 // StoreBB.
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011154 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11155 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman3a311d52008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011156 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011157 return false;
11158 }
11159 }
11160
11161 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
11162 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11163 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greifd6da1d02008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011164 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011165 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11166 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
11167 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11168 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
11169 }
11170
11171 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11172 // insert it.
Dan Gohman514277c2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011173 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011174 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11175 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11176
11177 // Nuke the old stores.
11178 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11179 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11180 ++NumCombined;
11181 return true;
11182}
11183
11184
11185Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11186 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
11187 Value *X = 0;
11188 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11189 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
11190 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11191 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11192 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11193 BI.setCondition(X);
11194 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11195 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11196 return &BI;
11197 }
11198
11199 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11200 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11201 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11202 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11203 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11204 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11205 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
11206 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
11207 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11208 NewSCC->takeName(I);
11209 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11210 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11211 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11212 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11213 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
11214 I->eraseFromParent();
11215 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
11216 return &BI;
11217 }
11218
11219 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11220 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11221 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11222 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11223 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11224 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11225 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11226 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
11227 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
11228 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11229 NewSCC->takeName(I);
11230 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11231 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11232 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11233 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11234 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
11235 I->eraseFromParent();;
11236 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
11237 return &BI;
11238 }
11239
11240 return 0;
11241}
11242
11243Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11244 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11245 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11246 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11247 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11248 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11249 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
11250 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
11251 AddRHS));
11252 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
11253 AddToWorkList(I);
11254 return &SI;
11255 }
11256 }
11257 return 0;
11258}
11259
Matthijs Kooijmanda9ef702008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011260Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman45e8eb42008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011261 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmanda9ef702008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011262
Matthijs Kooijman45e8eb42008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011263 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11265
11266 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11267 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
11268 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
11269
11270 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
11271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
11272
11273 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11274 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11275 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11276 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11277 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11278 // first index
11279 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11280 else
11281 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
11282 }
11283 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
11284 }
11285 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
11286 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
11287 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
11288 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
11289 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
11290 exti != exte && insi != inse;
11291 ++exti, ++insi) {
11292 if (*insi != *exti)
11293 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
11294 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
11295 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
11296 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
11297 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11298 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
11299 // with
11300 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
11301 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11302 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
11303 }
11304 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
11305 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
11306 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11307 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
11308 // with "i32 42"
11309 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
11310 if (exti == exte) {
11311 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
11312 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11313 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
11314 // with
11315 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
11316 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
11317 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11318 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11319 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11320 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11321 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11322 EV);
11323 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11324 insi, inse);
11325 }
11326 if (insi == inse)
11327 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11328 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11329 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11330 // i.e., replace
11331 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11332 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11333 // with
11334 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11335 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11336 exti, exte);
11337 }
11338 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11339 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11340 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11341 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmanda9ef702008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011342 return 0;
11343}
11344
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011345/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11346/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11347static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11348 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11349 return true;
11350 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
11351 if (isConstant) return true;
11352 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11353 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11354 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11355 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11356 return false;
11357 return true;
11358 }
11359 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11360 if (!I) return false;
11361
11362 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11363 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11364 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11365 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11366 return true;
11367 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11368 return true;
11369 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11370 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11371 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11372 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11373 return true;
11374 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11375 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11376 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11377 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11378 return true;
11379
11380 return false;
11381}
11382
11383/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11384///
11385/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11386/// elements in the input.
11387static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11388 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11389 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11390 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11391 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11392 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11393
11394 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
11395 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011396 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11397 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011398 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11399 else
Gabor Greif17396002008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011400 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011401 return Result;
11402}
11403
11404/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11405/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11406/// extracted from the vector.
11407static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
11408 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11409 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
11410 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11411 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
11412 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11413
11414 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11415 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11416 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11417 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
11418 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
11419 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11420 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11421 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
11422 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11423 return 0;
11424 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
11425
11426 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11427 // inserted value.
11428 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11429 return III->getOperand(1);
11430
11431 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11432 // vector input.
11433 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
11434 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011435 unsigned LHSWidth =
11436 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011437 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011438 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011439 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011440 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
11441 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011442 else
11443 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11444 }
11445
11446 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11447 return 0;
11448}
11449
11450Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011451 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
11452 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11453 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11454
11455 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
11456 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11457 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11458
11459 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmandd3425f2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011460 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11461 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11462 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011463 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11464 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11465 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11466 op0 = 0;
11467 break;
11468 }
11469 if (op0)
11470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
11471 }
11472
11473 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11474 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
11475 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11476 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11477 unsigned VectorWidth =
11478 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11479
11480 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11481 // crashing the code below.
11482 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11483 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11484
11485 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11486 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11487 // property.
11488 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
11489 uint64_t UndefElts;
11490 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
11491 1 << IndexVal,
11492 UndefElts)) {
11493 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11494 return &EI;
11495 }
11496 }
11497
11498 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11499 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
11500
11501 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11502 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11503 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11504 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11505 if (const VectorType *VT =
11506 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11507 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11508 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11509 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11510 }
11511 }
11512
11513 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11514 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11515 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11516 // profitable to do so
11517 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
11518 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11519 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11520 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11521 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11522 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11523 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11524 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11525 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11526 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11527 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greifa645dd32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011528 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011529 }
11530 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lambbb2f2222007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011531 unsigned AS =
11532 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner13c2d6e2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011533 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11534 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb91ea9d2008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011535 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11536 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011537 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11538 return new LoadInst(GEP);
11539 }
11540 }
11541 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11542 // Extracting the inserted element?
11543 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11545 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11546 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11547 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11548 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11549 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11550 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11551 return &EI;
11552 }
11553 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11554 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11555 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
11556 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11557 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
11558 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011559 unsigned LHSWidth =
11560 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11561
11562 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011563 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011564 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
11565 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011566 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11567 } else {
11568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11569 }
11570 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
11571 }
11572 }
11573 }
11574 return 0;
11575}
11576
11577/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11578/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11579/// Otherwise, return false.
11580static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11581 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11582 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11583 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
11584 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
11585
11586 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
11587 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11588 return true;
11589 } else if (V == LHS) {
11590 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
11591 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
11592 return true;
11593 } else if (V == RHS) {
11594 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
11595 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
11596 return true;
11597 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11598 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11599 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11600 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11601 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11602
11603 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11604 return false;
11605 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
11606
11607 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11608 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11609 // transitively ok.
11610 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11611 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
11612 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
11613 return true;
11614 }
11615 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11616 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
11617 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11618 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11619 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11620
11621 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11622 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11623 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11624 // transitively ok.
11625 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11626 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11627 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang6bf3c592008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011628 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011629 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
11630 } else {
11631 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang6bf3c592008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011632 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011633 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
11634
11635 }
11636 return true;
11637 }
11638 }
11639 }
11640 }
11641 }
11642 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11643
11644 return false;
11645}
11646
11647/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11648/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11649/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
11650static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
11651 Value *&RHS) {
11652 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
11653 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
11654 "Invalid shuffle!");
11655 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
11656
11657 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
11658 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11659 return V;
11660 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
11661 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
11662 return V;
11663 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11664 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11665 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11666 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11667 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11668
11669 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11670 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11671 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11672 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11673 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11674 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
11675
11676 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11677 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
11678 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11679 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11680 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang6bf3c592008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011681 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011682 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
11683 return V;
11684 }
11685
11686 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11687 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
11688 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11689 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11690 if (i != InsertedIdx)
11691 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
11692 }
11693 return V;
11694 }
11695
11696 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11697 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11698 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11699 return EI->getOperand(0);
11700
11701 }
11702 }
11703 }
11704 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11705
11706 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11707 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
11708 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
11709 return V;
11710}
11711
11712Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11713 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11714 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11715 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11716
11717 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11718 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11719 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11720
11721 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11722 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11723 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11724 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11725 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11726 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
11727 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11728 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11729 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
11730
11731 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11732 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11733
11734 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11736
11737 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11738 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11739 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11740 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11741
11742 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11743 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11744 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11745 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11746 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11747 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11748 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11749 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11750 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11751 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
11752 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11753 else {
11754 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
11755 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
11756 NumVectorElts));
11757 }
11758 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
11759 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
11760 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
11761 }
11762
11763 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11764 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11765 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11766 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11767 Value *RHS = 0;
11768 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11769 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11770 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
11771 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
11772 }
11773 }
11774 }
11775
11776 return 0;
11777}
11778
11779
11780Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11781 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11782 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
11783 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
11784
11785 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011786
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011787 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
11788 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
11789 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011790
11791 uint64_t UndefElts;
11792 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangbff5d9c2008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011793
11794 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
11795 return 0;
11796
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011797 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11798 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman83b702d2008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011799 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
11800 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11801 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohmanda93bbe2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011802 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman83b702d2008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011803 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011804
11805 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11806 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11807 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11808 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
11809 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11811 }
11812
11813 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11814 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11815 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11816 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11817 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11818 else {
11819 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohmanbba96b92008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011820 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011821 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohmanbba96b92008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011822 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11823 } else {
Mon P Wang6bf3c592008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011824 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohmanbba96b92008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011825 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11826 }
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011827 }
11828 }
11829 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
11830 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
11831 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
11832 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11833 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
11834 MadeChange = true;
11835 }
11836
11837 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
11838 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
11839
11840 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11841 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11842 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11843 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11844
11845 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11846 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
11847 }
11848
11849 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11850 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11851 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
11852
11853 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11854 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11855 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11856 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11857 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11858 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11859 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11860 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11861 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11862 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11863 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11864 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11865
11866 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11867 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11868 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11869 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11870 else
11871 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11872
11873 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11874 // the replacement.
11875 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11876 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11877 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11878 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
11879 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11880 } else {
11881 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
11882 }
11883 }
11884 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11885 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
11886 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
11887 }
11888 }
11889 }
11890
11891 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11892}
11893
11894
11895
11896
11897/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11898/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11899/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11900/// end of its block.
11901static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11902 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11903
11904 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnercb19a1c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011905 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11906 return false;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011907
11908 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
11909 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11910 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
11911 return false;
11912
11913 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11914 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner0db40a62008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011915 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11916 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011917 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11918 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11919 return false;
11920 }
11921
Dan Gohman514277c2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011922 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011923
11924 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
11925 ++NumSunkInst;
11926 return true;
11927}
11928
11929
11930/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11931/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11932///
11933/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11934/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11935/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11936/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11937/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11938///
11939static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
11940 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
11941 InstCombiner &IC,
11942 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnera06291a2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011943 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011944 Worklist.push_back(BB);
11945
11946 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11947 BB = Worklist.back();
11948 Worklist.pop_back();
11949
11950 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11951 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11952
11953 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11954 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
11955
11956 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11957 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11958 ++NumDeadInst;
11959 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11960 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11961 continue;
11962 }
11963
11964 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11965 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11966 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11967 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11968 ++NumConstProp;
11969 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11970 continue;
11971 }
Chris Lattnere0f462d2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011972
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011973 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
11974 }
11975
11976 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11977 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11978 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11979 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11980 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11981 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewyckyd551cf12008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011982 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewyckyd8aa33a2008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011983 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011984 continue;
11985 }
11986 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11987 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11988 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11989 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11990 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewyckyd551cf12008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011991 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewyckyd8aa33a2008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011992 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000011993 continue;
11994 }
11995
11996 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11997 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11998 continue;
11999 }
12000 }
12001
12002 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12003 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
12004 }
12005}
12006
12007bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
12008 bool Changed = false;
12009 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
12010
12011 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12012 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
12013
12014 {
12015 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12016 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12017 // track of which blocks we visit.
12018 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
12019 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
12020
12021 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12022 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12023 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12024 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12025 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12026 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12027 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12028 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
12029
12030 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
12031 ++NumDeadInst;
12032
12033 if (!I->use_empty())
12034 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
12035 I->eraseFromParent();
12036 }
12037 }
12038 }
12039
12040 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12041 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
12042 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
12043
12044 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
12045 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
12046 // Add operands to the worklist.
12047 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
12048 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
12049 ++NumDeadInst;
12050
12051 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
12052
12053 I->eraseFromParent();
12054 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
12055 continue;
12056 }
12057
12058 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
12059 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
12060 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
12061
12062 // Add operands to the worklist.
12063 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
12064 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
12065
12066 ++NumConstProp;
12067 I->eraseFromParent();
12068 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
12069 continue;
12070 }
12071
Nick Lewyckyadb67922008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012072 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
12073 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
12074 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
12075 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
12076 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
12077 i->set(NewC);
12078 }
12079 }
12080 }
12081
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000012082 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohman29474e92008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012083 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000012084 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
12085 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
12086 if (UserParent != BB) {
12087 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12088 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12089 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12090 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12091 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12092 break;
12093 }
12094
12095 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12096 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12097 // otherwise), we can keep going.
12098 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
12099 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
12100 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
12101 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
12102 }
12103 }
12104
12105 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
12106#ifndef NDEBUG
12107 std::string OrigI;
12108#endif
12109 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
12110 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
12111 ++NumCombined;
12112 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
12113 if (Result != I) {
12114 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
12115 << " New = " << *Result;
12116
12117 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12118 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12119
12120 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
12121 AddToWorkList(Result);
12122 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
12123
12124 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12125 Result->takeName(I);
12126
12127 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12128 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
12129 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12130
12131 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12132 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12133 ++InsertPos;
12134
12135 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
12136
12137 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
12138 // use counts.
12139 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
12140
12141 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
12142 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
12143 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
12144
12145 // Erase the old instruction.
12146 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
12147 } else {
12148#ifndef NDEBUG
12149 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
12150 << " New = " << *I;
12151#endif
12152
12153 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12154 // if so, remove it.
12155 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
12156 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
12157 // use counts.
12158 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
12159
12160 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
12161 // occurrences of this instruction.
12162 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
12163 I->eraseFromParent();
12164 } else {
12165 AddToWorkList(I);
12166 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
12167 }
12168 }
12169 Changed = true;
12170 }
12171 }
12172
12173 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnerb933ea62007-08-05 08:47:58 +000012174
12175 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
12176 WorklistMap.clear();
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000012177 return Changed;
12178}
12179
12180
12181bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
12182 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
12183
12184 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12185
12186 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12187 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlingd9644a42008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012188 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Dan Gohmanf17a25c2007-07-18 16:29:46 +000012189 EverMadeChange = true;
12190 return EverMadeChange;
12191}
12192
12193FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
12194 return new InstCombiner();
12195}
12196
Chris Lattner6297fc72008-08-11 22:06:05 +000012197